Shopping Cart

No products in the cart.

IEEE 802.3-2008

$250.00

IEEE Standard for Information technology–Telecommunications and information exchange between systems–Local and metropolitan area networks–Specific requirements Part 3: Carrier Sense Multiple Access with Collision Detection (CSMA/CD) Access Method and Physical Layer Specifications

Published By Publication Date Number of Pages
IEEE 2008
Guaranteed Safe Checkout
Category:

If you have any questions, feel free to reach out to our online customer service team by clicking on the bottom right corner. We’re here to assist you 24/7.
Email:[email protected]

Revision Standard – Superseded. Ethernet local area network operation is specified for selected speeds of operation from 1 Mb/s to 10 Gb/s using a common media access control (MAC) specification and management information base (MIB). The Carrier Sense Multiple Access with Collision Detection (CSMA/CD) MAC protocol specifies shared medium (half duplex) operation, as well as full duplex operation. Speed specific Media Independent Interfaces (MIIs) allow use of selected Physical Layer devices (PHY) for operation over coaxial, twisted pair or fiber optic cables. System considerations for multisegment shared access networks describe the use of Repeaters which are defined for operational speeds up to 1000 Mb/s. Local Area Network (LAN) operation is supported at all speeds.

PDF Catalog

PDF Pages PDF Title
1 802.3-2008_section1
IEEE Std 802.3™-2008, Front cover
3 Title page
6 Introduction
7 Notice to users
Laws and regulations
Copyrights
Updating of IEEE documents
Errata
Interpretations
8 Patents
Participants
20 Contents
SECTION ONE
31 SECTION TWO
41 SECTION THREE
48 SECTION FOUR
59 SECTION FIVE
75 Important notice
1. Introduction
1.1 Overview
1.1.1 Scope
76 1.1.2 Basic concepts
1.1.2.1 Half duplex operation
1.1.2.2 Full duplex operation
1.1.3 Architectural perspectives
77 1.1.3.1 Architectural rationale
1.1.3.2 Compatibility interfaces
79 1.1.4 Layer interfaces
1.1.5 Application areas
1.2 Notation
1.2.1 State diagram conventions
80 1.2.2 Service specification method and notation
81 1.2.2.1 Classification of service primitives
1.2.3 Physical Layer and media notation
82 1.2.4 Physical Layer message notation
1.2.5 Hexadecimal notation
1.3 Normative references
89 1.4 Definitions
113 1.5 Abbreviations
119 2. Media Access Control (MAC) service specification
2.1 Scope and field of application
2.2 Overview of the service
2.2.1 General description of services provided by the layer
2.2.2 Model used for the service specification
2.2.3 Overview of interactions
120 2.2.4 Basic services
2.3 Detailed service specification
2.3.1 MA_DATA.request
2.3.1.1 Function
2.3.1.2 Semantics of the service primitive
2.3.1.3 When generated
2.3.1.4 Effect of receipt
2.3.1.5 Additional comments
121 2.3.2 MA_DATA.indication
2.3.2.1 Function
2.3.2.2 Semantics of the service primitive
2.3.2.3 When generated
122 2.3.2.4 Effect of receipt
2.3.2.5 Additional comments
123 3. Media Access Control (MAC) frame and packet specifications
3.1 Overview
3.1.1 Packet format
124 3.1.2 Service interface mappings
3.2 Elements of the MAC frame and packet
3.2.1 Preamble field
3.2.2 Start Frame Delimiter (SFD) field
3.2.3 Address fields
125 3.2.3.1 Address designation
3.2.4 Destination Address field
126 3.2.5 Source Address field
3.2.6 Length/Type field
3.2.7 MAC Client Data field
127 3.2.8 Pad field
3.2.9 Frame Check Sequence (FCS) field
3.2.10 Extension field
128 3.3 Order of bit transmission
3.4 Invalid MAC frame
129 4. Media Access Control
4.1 Functional model of the MAC method
4.1.1 Overview
130 4.1.2 CSMA/CD operation
4.1.2.1 Normal operation
4.1.2.1.1 Transmission without contention
131 4.1.2.1.2 Reception without contention
4.1.2.2 Access interference and recovery
132 4.1.3 Relationships to the MAC client and Physical Layers
4.2 CSMA/CD Media Access Control (MAC) method: Precise specification
4.2.1 Introduction
4.2.2 Overview of the procedural model
133 4.2.2.1 Ground rules for the procedural model
4.2.2.2 Use of Pascal in the procedural model
134 4.2.2.3 Organization of the procedural model
4.2.2.4 Layer management extensions to procedural model
4.2.3 Packet transmission model
135 4.2.3.1 Transmit data encapsulation
140 4.2.3.2 Transmit media access management
4.2.3.2.1 Deference
4.2.3.2.2 Interpacket gap
141 4.2.3.2.3 Collision handling (half duplex mode only)
4.2.3.2.4 Collision detection and enforcement (half duplex mode only)
4.2.3.2.5 Collision backoff and retransmission (half duplex mode only)
142 4.2.3.2.6 Full duplex transmission
4.2.3.2.7 Packet bursting (half duplex mode only)
4.2.3.3 Minimum frame size
143 4.2.3.4 Carrier extension (half duplex mode only)
4.2.4 Frame reception model
4.2.4.1 Receive data decapsulation
4.2.4.1.1 Address recognition
144 4.2.4.1.2 Frame check sequence validation
4.2.4.1.3 Frame disassembly
4.2.4.2 Receive media access management
4.2.4.2.1 Framing
4.2.4.2.2 Collision filtering
145 4.2.5 Preamble generation
4.2.6 Start frame sequence
4.2.7 Global declarations
4.2.7.1 Common constants, types, and variables
147 4.2.7.2 Transmit state variables
148 4.2.7.3 Receive state variables
4.2.7.4 State variable initialization
149 4.2.8 Frame transmission
156 4.2.9 Frame reception
159 4.2.10 Common procedures
160 4.3 Interfaces to/from adjacent layers
4.3.1 Overview
4.3.2 MAC service
4.3.2.1 MAC client transmit interface state diagram
4.3.2.1.1 Variables
161 4.3.2.1.2 Functions
4.3.2.1.3 Messages
4.3.2.1.4 MAC client transmit interface state diagram
4.3.2.2 MAC client receive interface state diagram
4.3.2.2.1 Variables
162 4.3.2.2.2 Functions
4.3.2.2.3 Messages
4.3.2.2.4 MAC client receive interface state diagram
163 4.3.3 Services required from the Physical Layer
164 4.4 Specific implementations
4.4.1 Compatibility overview
165 4.4.2 MAC parameters
166 4.4.3 Configuration guidelines
167 5. Layer Management
5.1 Introduction
5.1.1 Systems Management overview
5.1.2 Layer Management model
168 5.1.3 Packages
5.1.4 Conformance requirements
5.2 Management facilities
5.2.1 Introduction
5.2.2 DTE MAC Sublayer Management facilities
170 5.2.2.1 DTE MAC sublayer attributes
5.2.2.1.1 aMACID
5.2.2.1.2 aFramesTransmittedOK
5.2.2.1.3 aSingleCollisionFrames
5.2.2.1.4 aMultipleCollisionFrames
171 5.2.2.1.5 aFramesReceivedOK
5.2.2.1.6 aFrameCheckSequenceErrors
5.2.2.1.7 aAlignmentErrors
5.2.2.1.8 aOctetsTransmittedOK
172 5.2.2.1.9 aFramesWithDeferredXmissions
5.2.2.1.10 aLateCollisions
5.2.2.1.11 aFramesAbortedDueToXSColls
5.2.2.1.12 aFramesLostDueToIntMACXmitError
173 5.2.2.1.13 aCarrierSenseErrors
5.2.2.1.14 aOctetsReceivedOK
5.2.2.1.15 aFramesLostDueToIntMACRcvError
5.2.2.1.16 aPromiscuousStatus
174 5.2.2.1.17 aReadMulticastAddressList
5.2.2.1.18 aMulticastFramesXmittedOK
5.2.2.1.19 aBroadcastFramesXmittedOK
5.2.2.1.20 aFramesWithExcessiveDeferral
175 5.2.2.1.21 aMulticastFramesReceivedOK
5.2.2.1.22 aBroadcastFramesReceivedOK
5.2.2.1.23 aInRangeLengthErrors
5.2.2.1.24 aOutOfRangeLengthField
176 5.2.2.1.25 aFrameTooLongErrors
5.2.2.1.26 aMACEnableStatus
5.2.2.1.27 aTransmitEnableStatus
5.2.2.1.28 aMulticastReceiveStatus
177 5.2.2.1.29 aReadWriteMACAddress
5.2.2.1.30 aCollisionFrames
5.2.2.2 DTE MAC Sublayer actions
5.2.2.2.1 acInitializeMAC
5.2.2.2.2 acAddGroupAddress
178 5.2.2.2.3 acDeleteGroupAddress
5.2.2.2.4 acExecuteSelfTest
5.2.2.3 ResourceTypeID Managed Object Class
5.2.2.3.1 ResourceTypeID
5.2.3 DTE Physical Sublayer Management facilities
5.2.3.1 DTE Physical Sublayer attributes
5.2.3.1.1 aPHYID
5.2.3.1.2 aSQETestErrors
179 5.2.4 DTE Management procedural model
5.2.4.1 Common constants and types
5.2.4.2 Transmit variables and procedures
181 5.2.4.3 Receive variables and procedures
183 5.2.4.4 Common procedures
185 6. Physical Signaling (PLS) service specifications
6.1 Scope and field of application
6.2 Overview of the service
6.2.1 General description of services provided by the layer
6.2.2 Model used for the service specification
6.2.3 Overview of interactions
186 6.2.4 Basic services and options
6.3 Detailed service specification
6.3.1 Peer-to-peer service primitives
6.3.1.1 PLS_DATA.request
6.3.1.1.1 Function
6.3.1.1.2 Semantics of the service primitive
6.3.1.1.3 When generated
6.3.1.1.4 Effect of receipt
187 6.3.1.2 PLS_DATA.indication
6.3.1.2.1 Function
6.3.1.2.2 Semantics of the service primitive
6.3.1.2.3 When generated
6.3.1.2.4 Effect of receipt
6.3.2 Sublayer-to-sublayer service primitives
6.3.2.1 PLS_CARRIER.indication
6.3.2.1.1 Function
6.3.2.1.2 Semantics of the service primitive
6.3.2.1.3 When generated
6.3.2.1.4 Effect of receipt
188 6.3.2.2 PLS_SIGNAL.indication
6.3.2.2.1 Function
6.3.2.2.2 Semantics of the service primitive
6.3.2.2.3 When generated
6.3.2.2.4 Effect of receipt
6.3.2.3 PLS_DATA_VALID.indication
6.3.2.3.1 Function
6.3.2.3.2 Semantics of the service primitive
6.3.2.3.3 When generated
6.3.2.3.4 Effect of receipt
189 7. Physical Signaling (PLS) and Attachment Unit Interface (AUI) specifications
7.1 Scope
7.1.1 Definitions
7.1.2 Summary of major concepts
190 7.1.3 Application
7.1.4 Modes of operation
7.1.5 Allocation of function
7.2 Functional specification
7.2.1 PLS–PMA (DTE–MAU) Interface protocol
191 7.2.1.1 PLS to PMA messages
7.2.1.1.1 output message
192 7.2.1.1.2 output_idle message
7.2.1.1.3 normal message
7.2.1.1.4 isolate message (optional)
7.2.1.1.5 mau_request message (optional)
194 7.2.1.2 PMA to PLS interface
7.2.1.2.1 input message
196 7.2.1.2.2 input_idle message
7.2.1.2.3 signal_quality_error message
7.2.1.2.4 mau_available message
7.2.1.2.5 mau_not_available message (optional)
197 7.2.2 PLS interface to MAC and management entities
7.2.2.1 PLS–MAC interface
7.2.2.1.1 OUTPUT_UNIT
7.2.2.1.2 OUTPUT_STATUS
7.2.2.1.3 INPUT_UNIT
7.2.2.1.4 CARRIER_STATUS
198 7.2.2.1.5 SIGNAL_STATUS
7.2.2.1.6 DATA_VALID_STATUS
7.2.2.2 PLS–management entity interface
7.2.2.2.1 RESET_REQUEST
199 7.2.2.2.2 RESET_RESPONSE
7.2.2.2.3 MODE_CONTROL
7.2.2.2.4 SQE_TEST
7.2.3 Frame structure
200 7.2.3.1 Silence
7.2.3.2 Preamble
7.2.3.3 Start of Frame Delimiter (SFD)
7.2.3.4 Data
7.2.3.5 End of transmission delimiter
7.2.4 PLS functions
201 7.2.4.1 Reset and Identify function
7.2.4.2 Mode function
202 7.2.4.3 Output function
7.2.4.4 Input function
7.2.4.5 Error Sense function
203 7.2.4.6 Carrier Sense function
7.3 Signal characteristics
7.3.1 Signal encoding
7.3.1.1 Data encoding
207 7.3.1.2 Control encoding
208 7.3.2 Signaling rate
7.3.3 Signaling levels
7.4 Electrical characteristics
7.4.1 Driver characteristics
7.4.1.1 Differential output voltage, loaded
210 7.4.1.2 Requirements after idle
7.4.1.3 AC common-mode output voltage
7.4.1.4 Differential output voltage, open circuit
7.4.1.5 DC common-mode output voltage
211 7.4.1.6 Fault tolerance
7.4.2 Receiver characteristics
7.4.2.1 Receiver threshold levels
212 7.4.2.2 AC differential input impedance
7.4.2.3 AC common-mode range
7.4.2.4 Total common-mode range
213 7.4.2.5 Idle input behavior
7.4.2.6 Fault tolerance
7.4.3 AUI cable characteristics
214 7.4.3.1 Conductor size
7.4.3.2 Pair-to-pair balanced crosstalk
7.4.3.3 Differential characteristic impedance
7.4.3.4 Transfer impedance
215 7.4.3.5 Attenuation
7.4.3.6 Timing jitter
7.4.3.7 Delay
7.5 Functional description of interchange circuits
7.5.1 General
7.5.2 Definition of interchange circuits
216 7.5.2.1 Circuit DO–Data Out
7.5.2.2 Circuit DI–Data In
7.5.2.3 Circuit CO–Control Out (optional)
7.5.2.4 Circuit CI–Control In
217 7.5.2.5 Circuit VP–Voltage Plus
7.5.2.6 Circuit VC–Voltage Common
7.5.2.7 Circuit PG–Protective Ground
7.5.2.8 Circuit shield terminations
7.6 Mechanical characteristics
7.6.1 Definition of mechanical interface
7.6.2 Line interface connector
218 7.6.3 Contact assignments
221 8. Medium Attachment Unit and baseband medium specifications, type 10BASE5
8.1 Scope
8.1.1 Overview
8.1.1.1 Medium Attachment Unit
222 8.1.1.2 Repeater unit
8.1.2 Definitions
8.1.3 Application perspective: MAU and MEDIUM objectives
8.1.3.1 Object
8.1.3.2 Compatibility considerations
223 8.1.3.3 Relationship to PLS and AU interface
8.1.3.4 Modes of operation
8.2 MAU functional specifications
8.2.1 MAU Physical Layer functions
8.2.1.1 Transmit function requirements
224 8.2.1.2 Receive function requirements
225 8.2.1.3 Collision Presence function requirements
8.2.1.4 Monitor function requirements (optional)
226 8.2.1.5 Jabber function requirements
8.2.2 MAU interface messages
8.2.2.1 DTE physical layer to MAU physical layer messages
227 8.2.2.2 MAU physical layer to DTE physical layer
8.2.2.2.1 input message
8.2.2.2.2 input_idle message
8.2.2.2.3 mau_available message
8.2.2.2.4 signal_quality_error message
228 8.2.3 MAU state diagrams
8.3 MAU–medium electrical characteristics
8.3.1 MAU-to-coaxial cable interface
8.3.1.1 Input impedance
229 8.3.1.2 Bias current
8.3.1.3 Coaxial cable signaling levels
235 8.3.1.4 Transmit output levels symmetry
8.3.1.5 Collision detect thresholds
8.3.2 MAU electrical characteristics
8.3.2.1 Electrical isolation
236 8.3.2.2 Power consumption
8.3.2.3 Reliability
8.3.3 MAU–DTE electrical characteristics
8.3.4 MAU–DTE mechanical connection
8.4 Characteristics of the coaxial cable
8.4.1 Coaxial cable electrical parameters
8.4.1.1 Characteristic impedance
8.4.1.2 Attenuation
237 8.4.1.3 Velocity of propagation
8.4.1.4 Edge jitter, untapped cable
8.4.1.5 Transfer impedance
8.4.1.6 Cable dc loop resistance
238 8.4.2 Coaxial cable properties
8.4.2.1 Mechanical requirements
8.4.2.1.1 General construction
8.4.2.1.2 Center conductor
8.4.2.1.3 Dielectric material
8.4.2.1.4 Shielding system
8.4.2.1.5 Overall jacket
239 8.4.2.2 Jacket marking
8.4.3 Total segment dc loop resistance
8.5 Coaxial trunk cable connectors
8.5.1 Inline coaxial extension connector
240 8.5.2 Coaxial cable terminator
8.5.2.1 Termination
8.5.2.2 Earthing
8.5.3 MAU-to-coaxial cable connection
8.5.3.1 Electrical requirements
241 8.5.3.2 Mechanical requirements
8.5.3.2.1 Connector housing
8.5.3.2.2 Contact reliability
242 8.5.3.2.3 Shield probe characteristics
8.6 System considerations
8.6.1 Transmission system model
243 8.6.2 Transmission system requirements
8.6.2.1 Cable sectioning
8.6.2.2 MAU placement
8.6.2.3 Trunk cable system grounding
244 8.6.3 Labeling
8.7 Environmental specifications
8.7.1 General safety requirements
8.7.2 Network safety requirements
8.7.2.1 Installations
245 8.7.2.2 Grounding
8.7.2.3 Safety
8.7.2.4 Breakdown path
8.7.2.5 Isolation boundary
8.7.2.6 Installation and maintenance guidelines
246 8.7.3 Electromagnetic environment
8.7.3.1 Susceptibility levels
8.7.3.2 Emission levels
8.7.4 Temperature and humidity
8.7.5 Regulatory requirements
247 8.8 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 8, Medium Attachment Unit and baseband medium specifications, type 10BASE5
8.8.1 Overview
8.8.2 Abbreviations and special symbols
8.8.2.1 Status symbols
8.8.2.2 Abbreviations
8.8.3 Instructions for completing the PICS proforma
8.8.3.1 General structure of the PICS proforma
248 8.8.3.2 Additional information
8.8.3.3 Exception information
8.8.3.4 Conditional items
249 8.8.4 Identification
8.8.4.1 Implementation identification
8.8.4.2 Protocol summary
8.8.5 Global statement of conformance
250 8.8.6 PICS proforma tables for MAU
8.8.6.1 MAU compatibility
8.8.6.2 Transmit function
251 8.8.6.3 Receive function
252 8.8.6.4 Collision function
8.8.6.5 Monitor function
253 8.8.6.6 Jabber function
254 8.8.6.7 MAU to coaxial cable interface
255 8.8.6.8 MAU electrical characteristics
8.8.6.9 MAU-DTE requirements
256 8.8.6.10 MAU to coaxial cable connection
8.8.6.11 Safety requirements
257 8.8.7 PICS proforma tables for MAU AUI characteristics
8.8.7.1 Signal characteristics
8.8.7.2 DI and CI driver characteristics
258 8.8.7.3 DO receiver characteristics
259 8.8.7.4 CO receiver characteristics
8.8.7.5 Circuit termination
260 8.8.7.6 Mechanical characteristics
261 8.8.8 PICS proforma tables for 10BASE5 coaxial cable
8.8.8.1 10BASE5 coaxial cable characteristics
263 9. Repeater unit for 10 Mb/s baseband networks
9.1 Overview
264 9.2 References
9.3 Definitions
9.4 Compatibility interface
9.4.1 AUI compatibility
9.4.2 Mixing segment compatibility
9.4.2.1 Direct coaxial cable attachment compatibility
9.4.2.2 “N” connector compatibility
9.4.2.3 BNC compatibility
9.4.2.4 BFOC/2.5 (10BASE-FP) compatibility
265 9.4.3 Link segment compatibility
9.4.3.1 Vendor-dependent IRL
9.4.3.2 Fiber optic FOIRL compatibility
9.4.3.3 Twisted-pair jack compatibility
9.4.3.4 Fiber optic 10BASE-FB and 10BASE-FL compatibility
9.5 Basic functions
9.5.1 Repeater set network properties
9.5.2 Signal amplification
9.5.3 Signal symmetry
266 9.5.4 Signal retiming
9.5.5 Data handling
9.5.5.1 Start-of-packet propagation delays
9.5.5.2 Start-of-packet variability
267 9.5.6 Collision handling
9.5.6.1 Collision presence
9.5.6.2 Jam generation
9.5.6.3 Collision-jam propagation delays
268 9.5.6.4 Transmit recovery time
9.5.6.5 Carrier recovery time
9.5.7 Electrical isolation
269 9.6 Detailed repeater functions and state diagrams
9.6.1 State diagram notation
272 9.6.2 Data and collision handling
9.6.3 Preamble regeneration
9.6.4 Fragment extension
273 9.6.5 MAU Jabber Lockup Protection
9.6.6 Auto-Partitioning/Reconnection (optional)
9.6.6.1 Overview
9.6.6.2 Detailed auto-partition/reconnection algorithm state diagram
276 9.7 Electrical isolation
9.7.1 Environment A requirements
9.7.2 Environment B requirements
9.8 Reliability
277 9.9 Medium attachment unit and baseband medium specification for a vendor- independent FOIRL
9.9.1 Scope
9.9.1.1 Overview
279 9.9.1.2 Application perspective: FOMAU and medium objectives
9.9.1.3 Compatibility considerations
9.9.1.4 Relationship to AUI
9.9.1.5 Mode of operation
9.9.2 FOMAU functional specifications
280 9.9.2.1 Transmit function requirements
281 9.9.2.2 Receive function requirements
9.9.2.3 Collision Presence function requirements
282 9.9.2.4 Jabber function requirements
9.9.2.5 Low Light Level Detection function requirements
283 9.9.2.6 Repeater Unit to FOMAU physical layer messages
9.9.2.7 FOMAU physical layer to repeater unit messages
9.9.2.7.1 input message
9.9.2.7.2 input_idle message
9.9.2.7.3 fomau_available message
9.9.2.7.4 signal_quality_error message
284 9.9.2.8 FOMAU state diagrams
285 9.9.3 FOMAU electrical characteristics
9.9.3.1 Electrical isolation
9.9.3.2 Power consumption
286 9.9.3.3 Reliability
9.9.3.4 FOMAU/Repeater unit electrical characteristics
9.9.3.5 FOMAU/Repeater unit mechanical connection
9.9.4 FOMAU/Optical medium interface
9.9.4.1 Transmit optical parameters
9.9.4.1.1 Wavelength
9.9.4.1.2 Spectral width
9.9.4.1.3 Optical modulation
9.9.4.1.4 Optical idle signal
9.9.4.1.5 Transmit optical logic polarity
288 9.9.4.1.6 Optical rise and fall times
9.9.4.1.7 Transmit optical pulse edge jitter
289 9.9.4.1.8 Peak coupled optical power
9.9.4.2 Receive optical parameters
9.9.4.2.1 Receive peak optical power range
9.9.4.2.2 Receive optical pulse edge jitter
9.9.4.2.3 Receive optical logic polarity
9.9.5 Characteristics of the optical fiber cable link segment
290 9.9.5.1 Optical fiber medium
9.9.5.2 Optical medium connector plug and socket
9.9.6 System requirements
9.9.6.1 Optical transmission system considerations
291 9.9.6.2 Timing considerations
292 9.9.7 Environmental specifications
9.9.7.1 Safety requirements
9.9.7.1.1 Electrical safety
9.9.7.1.2 Optical source safety
9.9.7.2 Electromagnetic environment
9.9.7.2.1 Susceptibility levels
9.9.7.2.2 Emission levels
293 9.9.7.3 Temperature and humidity
295 10. Medium attachment unit and baseband medium specifications, type 10BASE2
10.1 Scope
10.1.1 Overview
296 10.1.1.1 Medium attachment unit (normally contained within the data terminal equipment [DTE])
10.1.1.2 Repeater unit
10.1.2 Definitions
10.1.3 Application perspective: MAU and medium objectives
10.1.3.1 Object
297 10.1.3.2 Compatibility considerations
10.1.3.3 Relationship to PLS and AUI
10.1.3.4 Mode of operation
10.2 References
10.3 MAU functional specifications
298 10.3.1 MAU Physical Layer functional requirements
10.3.1.1 Transmit function requirements
299 10.3.1.2 Receive function requirements
10.3.1.3 Collision Presence function requirements
300 10.3.1.4 Jabber functional requirements
10.3.2 MAU interface messages
10.3.2.1 DTE to MAU messages
10.3.2.2 MAU to DTE messages
302 10.3.2.2.1 input message
10.3.2.2.2 input_idle message
10.3.2.2.3 mau_available message
10.3.2.2.4 signal_quality_error (SQE) message
10.3.3 MAU state diagrams
303 10.4 MAU–medium electrical characteristics
10.4.1 MAU-to-coaxial cable interface
10.4.1.1 Input impedance
10.4.1.2 Bias current
10.4.1.3 Coaxial cable signaling levels
305 10.4.1.4 Transmit output levels symmetry
10.4.1.5 Collision detect thresholds
10.4.2 MAU electrical characteristics
10.4.2.1 Electrical isolation
10.4.2.2 Power consumption
306 10.4.2.3 Reliability
10.4.3 MAU–DTE electrical characteristics
10.5 Characteristics of coaxial cable system
10.5.1 Coaxial cable electrical parameters
10.5.1.1 Characteristic impedance
10.5.1.2 Attenuation
10.5.1.3 Velocity of propagation
10.5.1.4 Edge jitter; entire segment without DTEs attached
307 10.5.1.5 Transfer impedance
10.5.1.6 Cable dc loop resistance
10.5.2 Coaxial cable physical parameters
10.5.2.1 Mechanical requirements
308 10.5.2.1.1 General construction
10.5.2.1.2 Center conductor
10.5.2.1.3 Dielectric material
10.5.2.1.4 Shielding system
10.5.2.1.5 Overall jacket
10.5.2.2 Jacket marking
10.5.3 Total segment dc loop resistance
309 10.6 Coaxial trunk cable connectors
10.6.1 In-line coaxial extension connector
310 10.6.2 Coaxial cable terminator
10.6.3 MAU-to-coaxial cable connection
10.7 System considerations
10.7.1 Transmission system model
312 10.7.2 Transmission system requirements
10.7.2.1 Cable sectioning
10.7.2.2 MAU placement
10.7.2.3 Trunk cable system earthing
10.7.2.4 Static discharge path
10.7.2.4.1 Installation environment
313 10.8 Environmental specifications
10.8.1 Safety requirements
10.8.1.1 Installations
10.8.1.2 Earthing
10.8.2 Electromagnetic environment
10.8.2.1 Susceptibility levels
10.8.2.2 Emission levels
10.8.3 Regulatory requirements
315 11. Broadband medium attachment unit and broadband medium specifications, type 10BROAD36
11.1 Scope
11.1.1 Overview
317 11.1.2 Definitions
11.1.3 MAU and medium objectives
318 11.1.4 Compatibility considerations
11.1.5 Relationship to PLS and AUI
11.1.6 Mode of operation
11.2 MAU functional specifications
11.2.1 MAU functional requirements
11.2.1.1 Transmit function requirements
319 11.2.1.2 Receive function requirements
11.2.1.3 Collision Detection function requirements
320 11.2.1.3.1 Collision enforcement transmitter requirements
11.2.1.3.2 Collision enforcement detection requirements
11.2.1.4 Jabber function requirements
321 11.2.2 DTE PLS to MAU and MAU to DTE PLS messages
11.2.2.1 DTE Physical Layer to MAU Physical Layer messages
11.2.2.2 MAU Physical Layer to DTE Physical Layer messages
11.2.2.2.1 input message
11.2.2.2.2 input_idle message
11.2.2.2.3 mau_available message
11.2.2.3 signal_quality_error message
322 11.2.3 MAU state diagrams
11.2.3.1 MAU state diagram messages
11.2.3.2 MAU state diagram signal names
325 11.3 MAU characteristics
11.3.1 MAU-to-coaxial cable interface
11.3.1.1 Receive interface
11.3.1.1.1 Receive input impedance
11.3.1.1.2 Receiver squelch requirements
326 11.3.1.1.3 Receive level requirements
11.3.1.1.4 Receiver selectivity and linearity requirements
11.3.1.1.5 Receive input mechanical requirements
11.3.1.2 Transmit interface
11.3.1.2.1 Transmit output impedance
11.3.1.2.2 Transmitted RF packet format
327 11.3.1.2.3 Transmit spectrum and group delay characteristics
329 11.3.1.2.4 Transmit out-of-band spectrum
11.3.1.2.5 Transmit level requirements
11.3.1.2.6 Nontransmitting signal leakage requirement
11.3.1.2.7 Transmit spurious output requirement
330 11.3.1.2.8 Collision enforcement signal leakage requirement
11.3.1.2.9 Transmit output mechanical requirements
11.3.2 MAU frequency allocations
11.3.2.1 Single-cable systems frequency allocations
331 11.3.2.2 Dual-cable systems frequency allocations
11.3.3 AUI electrical characteristics
11.3.3.1 Electrical isolation requirements
11.3.3.2 Current consumption
332 11.3.3.3 Driver and receiver requirements
11.3.3.4 AUI mechanical connection
11.3.4 MAU transfer characteristics
11.3.4.1 AUI to coaxial cable framing characteristics.
333 11.3.4.1.1 Scrambler and differential encoding requirements
334 11.3.4.2 Coaxial cable to AUI framing characteristics
335 11.3.4.3 Circuit DO to circuit DI framing characteristics
11.3.4.4 AUI to coaxial cable delay characteristics
11.3.4.4.1 Circuit DO to RF data signal delay
11.3.4.4.2 Circuit DO to CE RF output delay
11.3.4.4.3 Transmit postamble to SQE test signal delay
11.3.4.4.4 SQE test signal length
11.3.4.5 Coaxial cable to AUI delay characteristics
336 11.3.4.5.1 Received RF to circuit DI delay
11.3.4.5.2 Received RF to CE RF output and circuit CI delay
11.3.4.5.3 Collision enforcement to circuit CI delay
11.3.4.5.4 Receive data to SQE test delay
337 11.3.4.6 Delay from circuit DO to circuit DI
338 11.3.4.7 Interpacket gap requirement
11.3.4.8 Bit error ratio
11.3.5 Reliability
339 11.4 System considerations
11.4.1 Delay budget and network diameter
11.4.2 MAU operation with packets shorter than 512 bits
340 11.5 Characteristics of the coaxial cable system
11.5.1 Electrical requirements
11.5.2 Mechanical requirements
11.5.3 Delay requirements
341 11.6 Frequency translator requirements for the single-cable version
11.6.1 Electrical requirements
11.6.2 Mechanical requirements
11.7 Environmental specifications
11.7.1 Safety requirements
342 11.7.2 Electromagnetic environment
11.7.2.1 Susceptibility levels
11.7.2.2 Emission levels
11.7.3 Temperature and humidity
343 12. Physical signaling, medium attachment, and baseband medium specifications, type 1BASE5
12.1 Introduction
12.1.1 Overview
12.1.2 Scope
12.1.3 Definitions
12.1.4 General characteristics
344 12.1.5 Compatibility
12.1.6 Objectives of type 1BASE5 specification
12.2 Architecture
12.2.1 Major concepts
345 12.2.2 Application perspective
12.2.3 Packet structure
346 12.2.3.1 Silence
12.2.3.2 Preamble
347 12.2.3.3 Start-of-frame delimiter
12.2.3.4 Data
12.2.3.5 End-of-transmission delimiter
348 12.3 DTE physical signaling (PLS) specification
12.3.1 Overview
12.3.1.1 Summary of major concepts
12.3.1.2 Application perspective
349 12.3.2 Functional specification
12.3.2.1 PLS-PMA interface
12.3.2.1.1 output message
12.3.2.1.2 output_idle message
12.3.2.1.3 input message
12.3.2.1.4 input_idle message
350 12.3.2.2 PLS-MAC interface
12.3.2.2.1 OUTPUT_UNIT
12.3.2.2.2 OUTPUT_STATUS
12.3.2.2.3 INPUT_UNIT
12.3.2.2.4 CARRIER_STATUS
12.3.2.2.5 SIGNAL_STATUS
351 12.3.2.3 PLS functions
12.3.2.3.1 State diagram variables
12.3.2.3.2 Output function
352 12.3.2.3.3 Input function
12.3.2.3.4 Error Sense function
353 12.3.2.3.5 Carrier Sense function
12.3.2.4 Signal encoding
12.3.2.4.1 Data transmission rate
12.3.2.4.2 Data symbol encoding
12.3.2.4.3 Collision presence encoding
354 12.3.2.4.4 Idle line encoding
355 12.4 Hub specification
12.4.1 Overview
356 12.4.1.1 Summary of major concepts
12.4.1.2 Application perspective
12.4.2 Hub structure
12.4.2.1 Upward side
12.4.2.2 Downward side
357 12.4.3 Hub PLS functional specification
12.4.3.1 Hub PLS to PMA interface
12.4.3.2 Hub PLS functions
12.4.3.2.1 State diagram variables
358 12.4.3.2.2 Upward Signal Transfer function
12.4.3.2.3 Jabber function
359 12.4.3.2.4 Downward Signal Transfer function
361 12.4.3.2.5 Retiming (jitter removal)
12.4.3.2.6 Header hub wrap-around
12.4.3.2.7 Collision presence startup
362 12.4.3.3 Reliability
12.5 Physical medium attachment (PMA) specification
12.5.1 Overview
12.5.2 PLS–PMA interface
363 12.5.3 Signal characteristics
12.5.3.1 Transmitter characteristics
12.5.3.1.1 Differential output voltage
366 12.5.3.1.2 Output timing jitter
12.5.3.1.3 Transmitter impedance balance
367 12.5.3.1.4 Common-mode output voltage
12.5.3.1.5 Common-mode tolerance
368 12.5.3.1.6 Transmitter fault tolerance
12.5.3.2 Receiver characteristics
12.5.3.2.1 Differential input voltage
12.5.3.2.2 Input timing jitter
12.5.3.2.3 Idle input behavior
369 12.5.3.2.4 Differential input impedance
12.5.3.2.5 Common-mode rejection
370 12.5.3.2.6 Noise immunity
12.5.3.2.7 Receiver fault tolerance
12.6 Medium Dependent Interface (MDI) specification
12.6.1 Line interface connector
371 12.6.2 Connector contact assignments
12.6.3 Labeling
372 12.7 Cable medium characteristics
12.7.1 Overview
12.7.2 Transmission parameters
12.7.2.1 Attenuation
12.7.2.2 Differential characteristic impedance
12.7.2.3 Medium timing jitter
373 12.7.2.4 Dispersion
12.7.3 Coupling parameters
12.7.3.1 Pair-to-pair crosstalk
12.7.3.2 Multiple-disturber crosstalk
374 12.7.3.3 Balance
12.7.4 Noise environment
12.7.4.1 Impulse noise
375 12.7.4.2 Crosstalk
12.8 Special link specification
12.8.1 Overview
12.8.2 Transmission characteristics
12.8.3 Permitted configurations
12.9 Timing
12.9.1 Overview
376 12.9.2 DTE timing
12.9.3 Medium timing
12.9.4 Special link timing
12.9.5 Hub timing
377 12.10 Safety
12.10.1 Isolation
378 12.10.2 Telephony voltages
379 13. System considerations for multisegment 10 Mb/s baseband networks
13.1 Overview
380 13.1.1 Repeater usage
13.2 Definitions
13.3 Transmission System Model 1
386 13.4 Transmission System Model 2
13.4.1 Round-trip collision delay
13.4.1.1 Worst-case path delay value (PDV) selection
13.4.1.2 Worst-case PDV calculation
387 13.4.2 Interpacket gap (IPG) shrinkage
388 13.4.2.1 Worst-case path variability value (PVV) selection
13.4.2.2 Worst-case path variability value (PVV) calculation
13.5 Full duplex topology limitations
389 14. Twisted-pair medium attachment unit (MAU) and baseband medium, type 10BASE-T
14.1 Scope
14.1.1 Overview
14.1.1.1 Medium Attachment Unit (MAU)
390 14.1.1.2 Repeater unit
14.1.1.3 Twisted-pair media
14.1.2 Definitions
14.1.3 Application perspective
14.1.3.1 Objectives
391 14.1.3.2 Compatibility considerations
14.1.3.3 Modes of operation
392 14.1.4 Relationship to PLS and AUI
14.2 MAU functional specifications
393 14.2.1 MAU functions
14.2.1.1 Transmit function requirements
394 14.2.1.2 Receive function requirements
14.2.1.3 Loopback function requirements (half duplex mode only)
14.2.1.4 Collision Presence function requirements (half duplex mode only)
395 14.2.1.5 signal_quality_error Message (SQE) Test function requirements
14.2.1.6 Jabber function requirements
14.2.1.7 Link Integrity Test function requirements
396 14.2.1.8 Auto-Negotiation
397 14.2.2 PMA interface messages
14.2.2.1 PLS to PMA messages
14.2.2.1.1 PMA to PLS messages
14.2.2.2 PMA to twisted-pair link segment messages
14.2.2.3 Twisted-pair link segment to PMA messages
398 14.2.2.4 Interface message time references
14.2.3 MAU state diagrams
14.2.3.1 State diagram variables
404 14.2.3.2 State diagram timers
14.3 MAU electrical specifications
14.3.1 MAU-to-MDI interface characteristics
14.3.1.1 Isolation requirement
405 14.3.1.2 Transmitter specifications
14.3.1.2.1 Differential output voltage
408 14.3.1.2.2 Transmitter differential output impedance
409 14.3.1.2.3 Output timing jitter
14.3.1.2.4 Transmitter impedance balance
14.3.1.2.5 Common-mode output voltage
410 14.3.1.2.6 Transmitter common-mode rejection
14.3.1.2.7 Transmitter fault tolerance
411 14.3.1.3 Receiver specifications
14.3.1.3.1 Receiver differential input signals
412 14.3.1.3.2 Receiver differential noise immunity
14.3.1.3.3 Idle input behavior
14.3.1.3.4 Receiver differential input impedance
413 14.3.1.3.5 Common-mode rejection
14.3.1.3.6 Receiver fault tolerance
414 14.3.2 MAU-to-AUI specification
14.3.2.1 MAU-AUI electrical characteristics
14.3.2.2 MAU–AUI mechanical connection
14.3.2.3 Power consumption
14.4 Characteristics of the simplex link segment
14.4.1 Overview
14.4.2 Transmission parameters
14.4.2.1 Insertion loss
415 14.4.2.2 Differential characteristic impedance
14.4.2.3 Medium timing jitter
14.4.2.4 Delay
14.4.3 Coupling parameters
14.4.3.1 Differential near-end crosstalk (NEXT) loss
14.4.3.1.1 Twenty-five-pair cable and twenty-five-pair binder groups
416 14.4.3.1.2 Four-pair cable
14.4.3.1.3 Other cables
14.4.3.2 Multiple-disturber NEXT (MDNEXT) loss
14.4.4 Noise environment
14.4.4.1 Impulse noise
14.4.4.2 Crosstalk noise
417 14.5 MDI specification
14.5.1 MDI connectors
14.5.2 Crossover function
418 14.6 System considerations
419 14.7 Environmental specifications
14.7.1 General safety
14.7.2 Network safety
14.7.2.1 Installation
14.7.2.2 Grounding
14.7.2.3 Installation and maintenance guidelines
420 14.7.2.4 Telephony voltages
14.7.3 Environment
14.7.3.1 Electromagnetic emission
14.7.3.2 Temperature and humidity
14.8 MAU labeling
421 14.9 Timing summary
422 14.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 14, Twisted-pair medium attachment unit (MAU) and baseband medium, type 10BASE-T
14.10.1 Introduction
14.10.1.1 Scope
14.10.1.2 Reference
14.10.1.3 Definitions
14.10.1.4 Conformance
423 14.10.2 Identification of implementation
14.10.2.1 Supplier information
14.10.2.2 Implementation information
14.10.3 Identification of the protocol
424 14.10.4 PICS proforma for 10BASE-T
14.10.4.1 Abbreviations
14.10.4.2 PICS Completion instructions and implementation statement
14.10.4.3 Additional information
14.10.4.4 References
425 14.10.4.5 PICS proforma tables for MAU
14.10.4.5.1 MAU functions
426 14.10.4.5.2 Transmit function
14.10.4.5.3 Receive function
427 14.10.4.5.4 Loopback function
14.10.4.5.5 Collision Detect function
428 14.10.4.5.6 signal_quality_error Message Test function
14.10.4.5.7 Jabber function
429 14.10.4.5.8 Link Integrity Test function
430 14.10.4.5.9 MAU state diagram requirements
14.10.4.5.10 AUI requirements
14.10.4.5.11 Isolation requirements
431 14.10.4.5.12 Transmitter specification
432 14.10.4.5.13 Receiver specification
433 14.10.4.5.14 MDI requirements
14.10.4.5.15 Safety requirements
434 14.10.4.6 PICS proforma tables for MAU AUI characteristics
14.10.4.6.1 Signal characteristics
14.10.4.6.2 DI and CI driver characteristics
435 14.10.4.6.3 DO receiver characteristics
14.10.4.6.4 Power consumption
436 14.10.4.6.5 Circuit termination
14.10.4.6.6 Mechanical characteristics
437 14.10.4.7 PICS proforma tables for 10BASE-T link segment
14.10.4.7.1 10BASE-T link segment characteristics
438 14.10.4.8 PICS proforma tables for Auto-Negotiation able MAUs
439 15. Fiber optic medium and common elements of medium attachment units and star, type 10BASE-F
15.1 Scope
15.1.1 Overview
15.1.1.1 Fiber optic medium attachment units (MAUs)
15.1.1.2 Fiber optic passive star
440 15.1.1.3 Repeater unit
441 15.1.2 Definitions
15.1.3 Applications perspective: MAUs, stars, and fiber optic medium
15.1.3.1 Objectives
15.1.3.2 Compatibility considerations
442 15.1.3.3 Relationship to PLS and AUI
443 15.1.3.4 Guidelines for implementation of systems
15.1.3.5 Modes of operation
444 15.2 MDI optical characteristics
15.2.1 Transmit optical parameters
15.2.1.1 Center wavelength
15.2.1.2 Spectral width
15.2.1.3 Optical modulation extinction ratio
15.2.1.4 Optical Idle Signal amplitude
15.2.1.5 Optical transmit pulse logic polarity
15.2.1.6 Optical transmit pulse rise and fall times
15.2.1.7 Optical transmit pulse overshoot and undershoot
15.2.1.8 Optical transmit pulse edge jitter
446 15.2.1.9 Optical transmit pulse duty cycle distortion
15.2.1.10 Optical transmit average power range
15.2.1.11 Optical transmit signal templates
447 15.2.1.11.1 10BASE-FP optical transmit signal template
448 15.2.1.11.2 10BASE-FB optical transmit signal template
450 15.2.1.11.3 10BASE-FL Optical transmit signal template
451 15.2.2 Receive optical parameters
15.2.2.1 Optical receive average power range
15.2.2.2 Optical receive pulse edge jitter
452 15.2.2.3 Optical receive pulse logic polarity
15.2.2.4 Optical receive pulse rise and fall times
15.3 Characteristics of the fiber optic medium
15.3.1 Optical fiber and cable
15.3.1.1 Attenuation
15.3.1.2 Modal bandwidth
15.3.1.3 Propagation delay
453 15.3.2 Optical medium connector plug and socket
15.3.2.1 Optical connector insertion loss
15.3.2.2 Optical connector return loss
454 15.3.3 Fiber optic medium insertion loss
15.3.3.1 10BASE-FP segment insertion loss
15.3.3.2 10BASE-FB and 10BASE-FL segment insertion loss
15.3.4 Electrical isolation
15.4 MAU reliability
15.5 MAU–AUI specification
15.5.1 MAU–AUI electrical characteristics
455 15.5.2 MAU–AUI mechanical connections
15.5.3 Power consumption
15.5.4 MAU–AUI messages
15.5.4.1 PLS to PMA messages
15.5.4.2 PMA to PLS messages
15.5.4.2.1 signal_quality_error message
456 15.6 Environmental specifications
15.6.1 Safety requirements
15.6.2 Electromagnetic environment
457 15.6.3 Other environmental requirements
15.7 MAU labeling
15.7.1 10BASE-FP star labeling
458 15.8 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 15, Fiber optic medium and common elements of medium attachment units and star, type 10BASE-F
15.8.1 Introduction
15.8.2 Abbreviations and special symbols
15.8.2.1 Status symbols
15.8.2.2 Abbreviations
15.8.3 Instructions for completing the pics proforma
15.8.3.1 General structure of the PICS proforma
459 15.8.3.2 Additional information
15.8.3.3 Exception information
460 15.8.3.4 Conditional items
15.8.4 Identification
15.8.4.1 Implementation identification
15.8.4.2 Protocol summary
461 15.8.5 Major capabilities/options
15.8.6 PICS Proforma for the fiber optic medium
15.8.6.1 Characteristics of the fiber optic medium
462 15.8.6.2 Optical medium connector plug and socket
15.8.6.3 Fiber optic medium insertion loss
15.8.6.4 Electrical isolation requirements
463 16. Fiber optic passive star and medium attachment unit, type 10BASE-FP
16.1 Scope
16.1.1 Overview
16.1.1.1 10BASE-FP medium attachment unit
16.1.1.2 10BASE-FP Star
16.1.1.3 Repeater unit
464 16.2 PMA interface messages
16.2.1 PMA-to-MDI interface signal encodings
16.2.2 PMA-to-MDI OTD messages
16.2.2.1 OTD_output
16.2.2.2 OTD_idle
465 16.2.2.3 OTD_manch_violation
16.2.3 MDI ORD-to-PMA messages
16.2.3.1 ORD_input
466 16.2.3.2 ORD_idle
16.2.3.3 ORD_crv
16.3 10BASE-FP MAU functional specifications
16.3.1 Transmit function requirements
467 16.3.1.1 Preamble encoding
16.3.1.1.1 Synchronization pattern
16.3.1.1.2 Packet header code rule violation
16.3.1.1.3 Unique word
16.3.1.2 Data transmit
468 16.3.1.3 Collision encoding (unique word jam)
16.3.2 Receive function requirements
16.3.2.1 Preamble reconstruction and alignment
16.3.2.2 Data receive
16.3.2.3 Signal presence during collision
469 16.3.3 Loopback function requirements
16.3.4 Collision presence function requirements
16.3.4.1 CI Circuit signaling
16.3.4.2 Collision detection
470 16.3.4.3 End of collision
16.3.5 signal_quality_error Message (SQE) Test function requirements
16.3.6 Jabber function requirements
471 16.3.7 Link fault detection and low light function requirements
472 16.3.8 Interface message time references
16.3.9 MAU state diagram
16.3.9.1 MAU state diagram variables
474 16.3.9.2 MAU state diagram timers
475 16.3.9.3 MAU state diagram counters
480 16.4 Timing summary
16.5 10BASE-FP Star functional specifications
16.5.1 Star functions
16.5.1.1 Number of ports
16.5.1.2 Optical power division
481 16.5.1.3 Configuration
16.5.1.4 Reliability
16.5.2 Star optical characteristics
16.5.2.1 Star insertion loss
16.5.2.2 Star single output port uniformity
16.5.2.3 Star directivity
482 16.6 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 16, Fiber optic passive star and medium attachment unit, type 10BASE-FP
16.6.1 Introduction
16.6.2 Abbreviations and special symbols
16.6.2.1 Status symbols
16.6.2.2 Abbreviations
16.6.3 Instructions for completing the PICS proforma
16.6.3.1 General structure of the PICS proforma
483 16.6.3.2 Additional information
16.6.3.3 Exception information
484 16.6.3.4 Conditional items
16.6.4 Identification
16.6.4.1 Implementation identification
16.6.4.2 Protocol summary
485 16.6.5 Major capabilities/options
16.6.6 PICS proforma for the type 10BASE-FP MAU
16.6.6.1 Compatibility considerations
486 16.6.6.2 Optical transmit parameters
487 16.6.6.3 Optical receive parameters
16.6.6.4 Optical medium connector plug and socket
16.6.6.5 MAU functions
16.6.6.6 PMA interface messages
488 16.6.6.7 PMA to MDI OTD messages
16.6.6.8 MDI ORD to PMA messages
16.6.6.9 Transmit functions
489 16.6.6.10 Collision Encoding (Unique Word Jam) function
16.6.6.11 Receive functions
490 16.6.6.12 Preamble reconstruction and alignment function
16.6.6.13 Data receive function
16.6.6.14 Signal presence during collision
491 16.6.6.15 Loopback function
16.6.6.16 Collision presence function
492 16.6.6.17 signal_quality_error Message (SQE) test function
16.6.6.18 Jabber function
16.6.6.19 Link Fault Detect function
493 16.6.6.20 MAU state diagram requirements
16.6.6.21 MAU-to-AUI signal characteristics
16.6.6.22 MAU-to-AUI DI and CI driver characteristics
494 16.6.6.23 AUI-to-MAU DO receiver characteristics
16.6.6.24 MAU-to-AUI circuit termination
495 16.6.6.25 MAU-to-AUI mechanical connections
16.6.6.26 MAU reliability
496 16.6.6.27 Power consumption
16.6.6.28 PLS–PMA requirements
16.6.6.29 signal_quality_error message (SQE)
497 16.6.6.30 Environmental requirements
16.6.6.31 MAU labeling
16.6.7 PICS proforma tables for 10BASE-FP stars
16.6.7.1 Star basic functions
498 16.6.7.2 Star optical characteristics
16.6.7.3 Star environmental requirements
16.6.7.4 10BASE-FP star labeling
499 17. Fiber optic medium attachment unit, type 10BASE-FB
17.1 Scope
17.1.1 Overview
17.1.1.1 Medium attachment unit
17.1.1.2 Relationship to repeater
17.1.1.3 Remote diagnostic messages
17.1.2 Relationship to AUI
500 17.2 PMA interface messages
17.2.1 PMA-to-MDI interface signal encodings
17.2.2 PMA-to-MDI OTD messages
501 17.2.2.1 OTD_output
17.2.2.2 OTD_sync_idle
17.2.2.3 OTD_remote_fault
17.2.3 MDI ORD-to-PMA messages
17.2.3.1 Status decoding
17.2.3.2 ORD_input
17.2.3.3 ORD_sync_idle
17.2.3.4 ORD_remote_fault
502 17.2.3.5 ORD_invalid_data
17.2.4 Transitions between signals
17.2.5 Signaling rate
17.3 MAU functional specifications
17.3.1 Transmit function requirements
17.3.1.1 Data transmit
503 17.3.1.2 Synchronous idle
17.3.1.3 Fault signaling
17.3.2 Receive function requirements
17.3.2.1 Data receive
17.3.2.2 Remote status message handling
17.3.3 Collision function requirements
17.3.3.1 Collision detection
17.3.3.2 End of collision
504 17.3.4 Loopback function requirements
17.3.5 Fault-handling function requirements
17.3.6 Jabber function requirements
505 17.3.7 Low light level detection function requirements
17.3.8 Synchronous qualification function requirements
17.3.9 Interface message time references
506 17.3.10 MAU state diagrams
17.3.10.1 MAU state diagram variables
507 17.3.10.2 MAU state diagram timers
510 17.4 Timing summary
511 17.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 17, Fiber optic medium attachment unit, type 10BASE-FB
17.5.1 Introduction
17.5.2 Abbreviations and special symbols
17.5.2.1 Status symbols
17.5.2.1.1 Abbreviations
17.5.3 Instructions for completing the PICS proforma
17.5.3.1 General structure of the PICS proforma
512 17.5.3.2 Additional information
17.5.3.3 Exception information
513 17.5.3.4 Conditional items
17.5.4 Identification
17.5.4.1 Implementation identification
17.5.4.2 Protocol summary
17.5.5 PICS proforma for the type 10BASE-FB MAU
514 17.5.6 PICS proforma for the type 10BASE-FB MAU
17.5.6.1 Compatibility considerations
17.5.6.2 Optical transmit parameters
515 17.5.6.3 Optical receive parameters
17.5.6.4 Optical medium connector plug and socket
516 17.5.6.5 MAU functions
17.5.6.6 PMA-to-MDI OTD messages and signaling
517 17.5.6.7 MDI ORD-to-PMA messages and signaling
17.5.6.8 Transitions between signals
17.5.6.9 Signaling rate
518 17.5.6.10 Transmit functions
17.5.6.11 Receive functions
519 17.5.6.12 Data receive function
17.5.6.13 Remote status message handling
17.5.6.14 Collision function requirements
520 17.5.6.15 End of collision
17.5.6.16 Loopback function
17.5.6.17 Fault-handling function
521 17.5.6.18 Jabber-handling function
17.5.6.19 Low light detection
522 17.5.6.20 Synchronous qualification
17.5.6.21 MAU state diagram requirements
17.5.6.22 MAU reliability
523 17.5.6.23 PLS–PMA requirements
17.5.6.24 signal_quality_error message (SQE)
17.5.6.25 Environmental requirements
17.5.6.26 MAU labeling
525 18. Fiber optic medium attachment unit, type 10BASE-FL
18.1 Scope
18.1.1 Overview
18.1.1.1 10BASE-FL medium attachment unit (MAU)
18.1.1.2 Repeater unit
18.2 PMA interface messages
526 18.2.1 PMA to fiber optic link segment messages
18.2.1.1 OTD_output.
18.2.1.2 OTD_idle
18.2.2 Fiber optic link segment to PMA messages
18.2.2.1 ORD_input
18.2.2.2 ORD_idle
527 18.2.3 Interface message time references
18.3 MAU functional specifications
18.3.1 MAU functions
528 18.3.1.1 Transmit function requirements
529 18.3.1.2 Receive function requirements
18.3.1.3 Loopback function requirements (half duplex mode only)
18.3.1.4 Collision Presence function requirements (half duplex mode only)
530 18.3.1.5 signal_quality_error Message (SQE) Test function requirements
18.3.1.6 Jabber function requirements
18.3.1.7 Link Integrity Test function requirements
531 18.3.1.8 Auto-Negotiation
18.3.2 MAU state diagrams
18.3.2.1 MAU state diagram variables
533 18.3.2.2 MAU state diagram timers
538 18.4 Timing summary
539 18.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 18, Fiber optic medium attachment unit, type 10BASE-FL
18.5.1 Introduction
18.5.2 Abbreviations and special symbols
18.5.2.1 Status symbols
18.5.2.2 Abbreviations
540 18.5.3 Instructions for completing the PICS proforma
18.5.3.1 General structure of the PICS proforma
18.5.3.2 Additional information
18.5.3.3 Exception information
541 18.5.3.4 Conditional items
18.5.4 Identification
18.5.4.1 Implementation identification
18.5.4.2 Protocol summary
542 18.5.5 Major capabilities/options
18.5.6 PICS proforma tables for the type 10BASE-FL MAU
18.5.6.1 Compatibility considerations
543 18.5.6.2 Optical transmit parameter
544 18.5.6.3 Optical receive parameters
18.5.6.4 Optical medium connector plug and socket
545 18.5.6.5 MAU functions
18.5.6.6 PMA interface messages
18.5.6.7 PMA-to-MDI OTD messages
18.5.6.8 MDI ORD-to-PMA messages
546 18.5.6.9 Transmit function
18.5.6.10 Receive function
18.5.6.11 Loopback function
547 18.5.6.12 Collision Presence function
18.5.6.13 signal_quality_error Message (SQE) Test function
18.5.6.14 Jabber function
548 18.5.6.15 Link Integrity Test function
549 18.5.6.16 MAU state diagram requirements
18.5.6.17 MAU-to-AUI signal characteristics
550 18.5.6.18 MAU-to-AUI DI and CI driver characteristics
18.5.6.19 AUI-to-MAU DO receiver characteristics
551 18.5.6.20 AUI circuit termination
18.5.6.21 MAU-to-AUI mechanical connections
18.5.6.22 MAU reliability
552 18.5.6.23 Power consumption
18.5.6.24 PLS–PMA requirements
18.5.6.25 signal_quality_error message (SQE)
553 18.5.6.26 Environmental requirements
18.5.6.27 MAU labeling
555 19. Layer Management for 10 Mb/s baseband repeaters
19.1 Introduction
19.1.1 Scope
19.1.2 Relationship to objects in IEEE Std 802.1F-1993
19.1.3 Definitions
19.1.4 Symbols and abbreviations
556 19.1.5 Management model
557 19.2 Managed objects
19.2.1 Introduction
19.2.2 Overview of managed objects
19.2.2.1 Text description of managed objects
19.2.2.2 Port functions to support management
559 19.2.2.3 Containment
560 19.2.2.4 Naming
19.2.2.5 Packages and capabilities
562 19.2.3 Repeater managed object class
19.2.3.1 Repeater attributes
19.2.3.1.1 aRepeaterID
19.2.3.1.2 aRepeaterGroupCapacity
19.2.3.1.3 aGroupMap
19.2.3.1.4 aRepeaterHealthState
563 19.2.3.1.5 aRepeaterHealthText
19.2.3.1.6 aRepeaterHealthData
19.2.3.1.7 aTransmitCollisions
19.2.3.2 Repeater actions
19.2.3.2.1 acResetRepeater
564 19.2.3.2.2 acExecuteNonDisruptiveSelfTest
19.2.3.3 Repeater notifications
19.2.3.3.1 nRepeaterHealth
565 19.2.3.3.2 nRepeaterReset
19.2.3.3.3 nGroupMapChange
19.2.4 ResourceTypeID Managed Object Class
19.2.5 Group managed object class
19.2.5.1 Group attributes
19.2.5.1.1 aGroupID
566 19.2.5.1.2 aGroupPortCapacity
19.2.5.1.3 aPortMap
19.2.5.2 Group Notifications
19.2.5.2.1 nPortMapChange
19.2.6 Port managed object class
19.2.6.1 Port Attributes
19.2.6.1.1 aPortID
567 19.2.6.1.2 aPortAdminState
19.2.6.1.3 aAutoPartitionState
19.2.6.1.4 aReadableFrames
19.2.6.1.5 aReadableOctets
568 19.2.6.1.6 aFrameCheckSequenceErrors
19.2.6.1.7 aAlignmentErrors
19.2.6.1.8 aFramesTooLong
19.2.6.1.9 aShortEvents
569 19.2.6.1.10 aRunts
19.2.6.1.11 aCollisions
19.2.6.1.12 aLateEvents
570 19.2.6.1.13 aVeryLongEvents
19.2.6.1.14 aDataRateMismatches
19.2.6.1.15 aAutoPartitions
19.2.6.1.16 aLastSourceAddress
571 19.2.6.1.17 aSourceAddressChanges
19.2.6.2 Port Actions
19.2.6.2.1 acPortAdminControl
573 20. Layer Management for 10 Mb/s baseband medium attachment units
20.1 Introduction
20.1.1 Scope
20.1.2 Management model
20.2 Managed objects
20.2.1 Text description of managed objects
20.2.1.1 Naming
574 20.2.1.2 Containment
20.2.1.3 Packages
575 20.2.2 MAU Managed object class
20.2.2.1 MAU attributes
20.2.2.1.1 aMAUID
20.2.2.1.2 aMAUType
576 20.2.2.1.3 aMediaAvailable
20.2.2.1.4 aLoseMediaCounter
20.2.2.1.5 aJabber
577 20.2.2.1.6 aMAUAdminState
20.2.2.1.7 aBbMAUXmitRcvSplitType
20.2.2.1.8 aBroadbandFrequencies
578 20.2.2.2 MAU actions
20.2.2.2.1 acResetMAU
20.2.2.2.2 acMAUAdminControl
20.2.2.3 MAU notifications
20.2.2.3.1 nJabber
579 Annex A (informative) Bibliography
583 Annex B (informative) System guidelines
B.1 Baseband system guidelines and concepts, 10 Mb/s
B.1.1 Overall system objectives
B.1.2 Analog system components and parameter values
585 B.1.3 Minimum frame length determination
586 B.1.4 System jitter budgets
B.1.4.1 Nominal jitter values
587 B.1.4.2 Decoder evaluation
588 B.1.5 Systems consideration calculations
B.1.5.1 Overview
B.1.5.2 Maximum collision fragment size
591 B.1.5.3 Interpacket Gap (IPG) shrinkage
592 B.1.5.4 Timing parameters for round-trip delay and variability calculations
595 B.2 System parameters and budgets for 1BASE5
B.2.1 Delay budget
596 B.2.2 Minimum frame length determination
597 B.2.3 Jitter budget
598 B.3 Example crosstalk computation for multiple disturbers, balanced-pair cable
600 B.4 10BASE-T guidelines
B.4.1 System jitter budget
B.4.2 Filter characteristics
B.4.3 Notes for conformance testing
B.4.3.1 Notes for 14.3.1.2.1 on differential output voltage
601 B.4.3.2 Note for 14.3.1.2.2 on transmitter differential output impedance
B.4.3.3 Note for 14.3.1.2.3 on output timing jitter
602 B.4.3.4 General note on common-mode tests
B.4.3.5 Note for 14.3.1.3.4 on receiver differential input impedance
B.4.3.6 Note for 14.3.1.3.3 on receiver idle input behavior
B.4.3.7 Note for 14.3.1.3.5 on receiver common-mode rejection
603 B.5 10BASE-F
B.5.1 System jitter budget
B.5.2 10BASE-FP fiber optic segment loss budget
606 Annex C (informative) State diagram, MAC sublayer
607 Annex D (informative) Application context, selected medium specifications
D.1 Introduction
D.2 Type 10BASE5 applications
D.3 Type 10BASE2 applications
608 D.4 Type FOIRL and 10BASE-F applications; alternative fiber optic medium applications
D.4.1 Alternative fiber types
D.4.1.1 Theoretical coupling losses
609 D.4.1.2 Maximum launch power
610 D.4.2 Type 10BASE-FP applications using 50/125 µm fiber
D.4.2.1 Coupled transmit power
D.4.2.2 Star coupler loss
611 D.4.2.3 Collision detection
D.5 10BASE-T use of cabling systems with a nominal differential characteristic impedance of 120 W
612 D.6 10BASE-T use of cabling systems with a nominal differential characteristic impedance of 150 W
614 Annex E (informative) Receiver wavelength design considerations (FOIRL)
615 Annex F (normative) Additional attributes required for systems
F.1 Introduction
F.1.1 Scope
F.2 Objects/Attributes/Actions/Notifications
F.2.1 TimeSinceSystemReset attribute
616 F.2.2 RepeaterResetTimeStamp attribute
F.2.3 ResetSystemAction action
617 Annex G (normative) Additional material required for conformance testing
G.1 Introduction
G.1.1 Material in support of the aDataRateMismatches attribute
618 Annex H (normative) GDMO specifications for CSMA/CD managed objects
H.1 Use of MAC and PLS Sublayer Management Definitions with CMIS/CMIP and ISO/IEC 15802-2: 1995 Management Protocols
H.1.1 DTE MAC sublayer managed object class
H.1.1.1 DTE MAC sublayer formal definition
620 H.1.1.2 DTE MAC sublayer attributes
626 H.1.1.3 DTE MAC sublayer actions
627 H.1.2 ResourceTypeID managed object class
H.1.2.1 ResourceTypeID, formal definition
H.1.3 DTE physical layer managed object class
H.1.3.1 DTE physical layer formal definition
628 H.1.3.2 DTE physical sublayer attributes
H.2 GDMO specification for Repeater Management Object Class
629 H.2.1 Repeater managed object class
H.2.1.1 Repeater, formal definition
630 H.2.1.2 Repeater attributes
631 H.2.1.3 Repeater actions
H.2.1.4 Repeater notifications
632 H.2.2 ResourceTypeID managed object class
H.2.2.1 ResourceTypeID formal definition
633 H.2.3 Group managed object class
H.2.3.1 Group formal definition
H.2.3.2 Group attributes
634 H.2.3.3 Group notifications
H.2.4 Port managed object class
H.2.4.1 Port formal definition
635 H.2.4.2 Port attributes
638 H.2.4.3 Port actions
H.2.5 Common Attributes Template
639 H.3 GDMO specification for MAU Management Objects
H.3.1 MAU Managed Object Class
H.3.1.1 MAU formal definition
640 H.3.1.2 MAU attributes
642 H.3.1.3 MAU actions
H.3.1.4 MAU notifications
H.4 GDMO and ASN.1 definitions for management
H.4.1 Common Attributes Template
643 H.4.2 ASN.1 module
647 Annex 4A (normative) Simplified full duplex media access control
4A.1 Functional model of the MAC method
4A.1.1 Overview
648 4A.1.2 Full duplex operation
4A.1.2.1 Transmission
4A.1.2.2 Reception
649 4A.1.3 Relationships to the MAC client and Physical Layers
4A.2 Media access control (MAC) method: precise specification
4A.2.1 Introduction
4A.2.2 Overview of the procedural model
4A.2.2.1 Ground rules for the procedural model
650 4A.2.2.2 Use of Pascal in the procedural model
4A.2.2.3 Organization of the procedural model
655 4A.2.2.4 Layer management extensions to procedural model
4A.2.3 Packet transmission model
4A.2.3.1 Transmit data encapsulation
4A.2.3.2 Transmit media access management
656 4A.2.4 Frame reception model
4A.2.4.1 Receive data decapsulation
657 4A.2.4.2 Receive media access management
4A.2.5 Preamble generation
4A.2.6 Start frame sequence
658 4A.2.7 Global declarations
4A.2.7.1 Common constants, types, and variables
659 4A.2.7.2 Transmit state variables
4A.2.7.3 Receive state variables
4A.2.7.4 State variable initialization
660 4A.2.8 Frame transmission
663 4A.2.9 Frame reception
666 4A.2.10 Common procedures
4A.3 Interfaces to/from adjacent layers
4A.3.1 Overview
4A.3.2 MAC service
4A.3.2.1 MAC client transmit interface state diagram
667 4A.3.2.2 MAC client receive interface state diagram
669 4A.3.3 Services required from the Physical Layer
670 4A.4 Specific implementations
4A.4.1 Compatibility overview
4A.4.2 MAC parameters
672 802.3-2008_section2
SECTION TWO
21. Introduction to 100 Mb/s baseband networks, type 100BASE-T
21.1 Overview
21.1.1 Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and Media Independent Interface (MII)
673 21.1.2 Physical Layer signaling systems
21.1.3 Repeater
21.1.4 Auto-Negotiation
674 21.1.5 Management
21.2 References
21.3 Definitions
21.4 Abbreviations
21.5 State diagrams
21.5.1 Actions inside state blocks
21.5.2 State diagram variables
675 21.5.3 State transitions
21.5.4 Operators
676 21.6 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma
21.6.1 Introduction
21.6.2 Abbreviations and special symbols
21.6.3 Instructions for completing the PICS proforma
677 21.6.4 Additional information
21.6.5 Exceptional information
21.6.6 Conditional items
678 21.7 Relation of 100BASE-T to other standards
679 21.8 MAC delay constraints (exposed MII)
680 22. Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and Media Independent Interface (MII)
22.1 Overview
681 22.1.1 Summary of major concepts
22.1.2 Application
682 22.1.3 Rates of operation
22.1.4 Allocation of functions
22.1.5 Relationship of MII and GMII
22.2 Functional specifications
22.2.1 Mapping of MII signals to PLS service primitives and Station Management
683 22.2.1.1 Mapping of PLS_DATA.request
22.2.1.1.1 Function
22.2.1.1.2 Semantics of the service primitive
22.2.1.1.3 When generated
684 22.2.1.2 Mapping of PLS_DATA.indication
22.2.1.2.1 Function
22.2.1.2.2 Semantics of the service primitive
22.2.1.2.3 When generated
22.2.1.3 Mapping of PLS_CARRIER.indication
22.2.1.3.1 Function
22.2.1.3.2 Semantics of the service primitive
22.2.1.3.3 When generated
685 22.2.1.4 Mapping of PLS_SIGNAL.indication
22.2.1.4.1 Function
22.2.1.4.2 Semantics of the service primitive
22.2.1.4.3 When generated
22.2.1.5 Response to RX_ER indication from MII
22.2.1.6 Conditions for generation of TX_ER
22.2.1.7 Mapping of PLS_DATA_VALID.indication
22.2.1.7.1 Function
686 22.2.1.7.2 Semantics of the service primitive
22.2.1.7.3 When generated
22.2.2 MII signal functional specifications
22.2.2.1 TX_CLK (transmit clock)
22.2.2.2 RX_CLK (receive clock)
687 22.2.2.3 TX_EN (transmit enable)
22.2.2.4 TXD (transmit data)
688 22.2.2.5 TX_ER (transmit coding error)
22.2.2.6 RX_DV (Receive Data Valid)
22.2.2.7 RXD (receive data)
690 22.2.2.8 RX_ER (receive error)
691 22.2.2.9 CRS (carrier sense)
22.2.2.10 COL (collision detected)
692 22.2.2.11 MDC (management data clock)
22.2.2.12 MDIO (management data input/output)
22.2.3 MII data stream
693 22.2.3.1 Inter-frame
22.2.3.2 Preamble and start of frame delimiter
22.2.3.2.1 Transmit case
22.2.3.2.2 Receive case
694 22.2.3.3 Data
22.2.3.4 End-of-Frame delimiter (EFD)
22.2.3.5 Handling of excess nibbles
695 22.2.4 Management functions
696 22.2.4.1 Control register (Register 0)
697 22.2.4.1.1 Reset
22.2.4.1.2 Loopback
22.2.4.1.3 Speed selection
22.2.4.1.4 Auto-Negotiation enable
698 22.2.4.1.5 Power down
22.2.4.1.6 Isolate
22.2.4.1.7 Restart Auto-Negotiation
699 22.2.4.1.8 Duplex mode
22.2.4.1.9 Collision test
22.2.4.1.10 Speed selection
22.2.4.1.11 Reserved bits
22.2.4.1.12 Unidirectional enable
700 22.2.4.2 Status register (Register 1)
701 22.2.4.2.1 100BASE-T4 ability
22.2.4.2.2 100BASE-X full duplex ability
22.2.4.2.3 100BASE-X half duplex ability
22.2.4.2.4 10 Mb/s full duplex ability
22.2.4.2.5 10 Mb/s half duplex ability
22.2.4.2.6 100BASE-T2 full duplex ability
702 22.2.4.2.7 100BASE-T2 half duplex ability
22.2.4.2.8 Unidirectional ability
22.2.4.2.9 MF preamble suppression ability
22.2.4.2.10 Auto-Negotiation complete
22.2.4.2.11 Remote fault
22.2.4.2.12 Auto-Negotiation ability
22.2.4.2.13 Link Status
703 22.2.4.2.14 Jabber detect
22.2.4.2.15 Extended capability
22.2.4.2.16 Extended status
22.2.4.3 Extended capability registers
22.2.4.3.1 PHY Identifier (Registers 2 and 3)
704 22.2.4.3.2 Auto-Negotiation advertisement (Register 4)
22.2.4.3.3 Auto-Negotiation link partner ability (Register 5)
22.2.4.3.4 Auto-Negotiation expansion (Register 6)
22.2.4.3.5 Auto-Negotiation Next Page (Register 7)
22.2.4.3.6 Auto-Negotiation link partner Received Next Page (Register 8)
705 22.2.4.3.7 MASTER-SLAVE control register (Register 9)
22.2.4.3.8 MASTER-SLAVE status register (Register 10)
22.2.4.3.9 PSE Control register (Register 11)
22.2.4.3.10 PSE Status register (Register 12)
22.2.4.3.11 MMD access control register (Register 13)
706 22.2.4.3.12 MMD access address data register (Register 14)
22.2.4.3.13 PHY specific registers
22.2.4.4 Extended Status register (Register 15)
22.2.4.4.1 1000BASE-X full duplex ability
707 22.2.4.4.2 1000BASE-X half duplex ability
22.2.4.4.3 1000BASE-T full duplex ability
22.2.4.4.4 1000BASE-T half duplex ability
22.2.4.4.5 Reserved bits
22.2.4.5 Management frame structure
22.2.4.5.1 IDLE (IDLE condition)
708 22.2.4.5.2 PRE (preamble)
22.2.4.5.3 ST (start of frame)
22.2.4.5.4 OP (operation code)
22.2.4.5.5 PHYAD (PHY Address)
22.2.4.5.6 REGAD (Register Address)
22.2.4.5.7 TA (turnaround)
709 22.2.4.5.8 DATA (data)
22.3 Signal timing characteristics
22.3.1 Signals that are synchronous to TX_CLK
710 22.3.1.1 TX_EN
22.3.1.2 TXD
22.3.1.3 TX_ER
22.3.2 Signals that are synchronous to RX_CLK
22.3.2.1 RX_DV
22.3.2.2 RXD
22.3.2.3 RX_ER
711 22.3.3 Signals that have no required clock relationship
22.3.3.1 CRS
22.3.3.2 COL
22.3.4 MDIO timing relationship to MDC
712 22.4 Electrical characteristics
22.4.1 Signal levels
22.4.2 Signal paths
713 22.4.3 Driver characteristics
22.4.3.1 DC characteristics
22.4.3.2 AC characteristics
22.4.4 Receiver characteristics
22.4.4.1 Voltage thresholds
22.4.4.2 Input current
714 22.4.4.3 Input capacitance
22.4.5 Cable characteristics
715 22.4.5.1 Conductor size
22.4.5.2 Characteristic impedance
22.4.5.3 Delay
22.4.5.4 Delay variation
22.4.5.5 Shielding
22.4.5.6 DC resistance
22.4.6 Hot insertion and removal
716 22.5 Power supply
22.5.1 Supply voltage
22.5.2 Load current
22.5.3 Short-circuit protection
22.6 Mechanical characteristics
22.6.1 Definition of mechanical interface
717 22.6.2 Shielding effectiveness and transfer impedance
22.6.3 Connector pin numbering
22.6.4 Clearance dimensions
718 22.6.5 Contact assignments
719 22.7 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 22, Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and Media Independent Interface (MII)
22.7.1 Introduction
22.7.2 Identification
22.7.2.1 Implementation identification
22.7.2.2 Protocol summary
720 22.7.2.3 Major capabilities/options
22.7.3 PICS proforma tables for reconciliation sublayer and media independent interface
22.7.3.1 Mapping of PLS service primitives
22.7.3.2 MII signal functional specifications
722 22.7.3.3 Frame structure
22.7.3.4 Management functions
726 22.7.3.5 Signal timing characteristics
727 22.7.3.6 Electrical characteristics
729 22.7.3.7 Power supply
22.7.3.8 Mechanical characteristics
730 23. Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer and baseband medium, type 100BASE-T4
23.1 Overview
23.1.1 Scope
23.1.2 Objectives
23.1.3 Relation of 100BASE-T4 to other standards
23.1.4 Summary
731 23.1.4.1 Summary of Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) specification
733 23.1.4.2 Summary of physical medium attachment (PMA) specification
23.1.5 Application of 100BASE-T4
23.1.5.1 Compatibility considerations
734 23.1.5.2 Incorporating the 100BASE-T4 PHY into a DTE
23.1.5.3 Use of 100BASE-T4 PHY for point-to-point communication
23.1.5.4 Support for Auto-Negotiation
23.2 PCS functional specifications
23.2.1 PCS functions
23.2.1.1 PCS Reset function
735 23.2.1.2 PCS Transmit function
736 23.2.1.2.1 DC balance encoding rules
23.2.1.3 PCS Receive function
737 23.2.1.3.1 Error-detecting rules
738 23.2.1.4 PCS Error Sense function
23.2.1.5 PCS Carrier Sense function
23.2.1.6 PCS Collision Presence function
739 23.2.2 PCS interfaces
23.2.2.1 PCS–MII interface signals
23.2.2.2 PCS–Management entity signals
23.2.3 Frame structure
740 23.2.4 PCS state diagrams
23.2.4.1 PCS state diagram constants
741 23.2.4.2 PCS state diagram variables
744 23.2.4.3 PCS state diagram timer
23.2.4.4 PCS state diagram functions
746 23.2.4.5 PCS state diagrams
748 23.2.5 PCS electrical specifications
23.3 PMA service interface
749 23.3.1 PMA_TYPE.indication
23.3.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
23.3.1.2 When generated
23.3.1.3 Effect of receipt
23.3.2 PMA_UNITDATA.request
23.3.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
750 23.3.2.2 When generated
23.3.2.3 Effect of receipt
23.3.3 PMA_UNITDATA.indication
23.3.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
23.3.3.2 When generated
751 23.3.3.3 Effect of receipt
23.3.4 PMA_CARRIER.indication
23.3.4.1 Semantics of the service primitive
23.3.4.2 When generated
23.3.4.3 Effect of receipt
23.3.5 PMA_LINK.indication
23.3.5.1 Semantics of the service primitive
23.3.5.2 When generated
23.3.5.3 Effect of receipt
752 23.3.6 PMA_LINK.request
23.3.6.1 Semantics of the service primitive
23.3.6.2 Default value of parameter link_control
23.3.6.3 When generated
23.3.6.4 Effect of receipt
753 23.3.7 PMA_RXERROR.indication
23.3.7.1 Semantics of the service primitive
23.3.7.2 When generated
23.3.7.3 Effect of receipt
23.4 PMA functional specifications
23.4.1 PMA functions
23.4.1.1 PMA Reset function
754 23.4.1.2 PMA Transmit function
755 23.4.1.3 PMA Receive function
23.4.1.4 PMA Carrier Sense function
756 23.4.1.5 Link Integrity function
23.4.1.6 PMA Align function
757 23.4.1.7 Clock Recovery function
23.4.2 PMA interface messages
758 23.4.3 PMA state diagrams
23.4.3.1 PMA constants
759 23.4.3.2 State diagram variables
23.4.3.3 State diagram timers
760 23.4.3.4 State diagram counters
23.4.3.5 Link Integrity state diagram
23.5 PMA electrical specifications
23.5.1 PMA-to-MDI interface characteristics
23.5.1.1 Isolation requirement
761 23.5.1.2 Transmitter specifications
23.5.1.2.1 Peak differential output voltage
762 23.5.1.2.2 Differential output templates
766 23.5.1.2.3 Differential output ISI (intersymbol interference)
768 23.5.1.2.4 Transmitter differential output impedance
769 23.5.1.2.5 Output timing jitter
23.5.1.2.6 Transmitter impedance balance
770 23.5.1.2.7 Common-mode output voltage
23.5.1.2.8 Transmitter common-mode rejection
771 23.5.1.2.9 Transmitter fault tolerance
23.5.1.2.10 Transmit clock frequency
23.5.1.3 Receiver specifications
772 23.5.1.3.1 Receiver differential input signals
773 23.5.1.3.2 Receiver differential noise immunity
23.5.1.3.3 Receiver differential input impedance
23.5.1.3.4 Common-mode rejection
774 23.5.1.3.5 Receiver fault tolerance
23.5.1.3.6 Receiver frequency tolerance
23.5.2 Power consumption
23.6 Link segment characteristics
23.6.1 Cabling
775 23.6.2 Link transmission parameters
23.6.2.1 Insertion loss
23.6.2.2 Differential characteristic impedance
23.6.2.3 Coupling parameters
23.6.2.3.1 Differential Near-End Crosstalk (NEXT) loss
23.6.2.3.2 Multiple-disturber NEXT (MDNEXT) loss
776 23.6.2.3.3 Equal Level Far-End Crosstalk (ELFEXT) loss
23.6.2.3.4 Multiple-disturber ELFEXT (MDELFEXT) loss
23.6.2.4 Delay
23.6.2.4.1 Maximum link delay
23.6.2.4.2 Maximum link delay per meter
777 23.6.2.4.3 Difference in link delays
23.6.3 Noise
23.6.3.1 Near-End Crosstalk
23.6.3.2 Far-End Crosstalk
778 23.6.4 Installation practice
23.6.4.1 Connector installation practices
23.6.4.2 Disallow use of Category 3 cable with more than four pairs
23.6.4.3 Allow use of Category 5 jumpers with up to 25 pairs
23.7 MDI specification
23.7.1 MDI connectors
779 23.7.2 Crossover function
23.8 System considerations
780 23.9 Environmental specifications
23.9.1 General safety
23.9.2 Network safety
781 23.9.2.1 Installation
23.9.2.2 Grounding
23.9.2.3 Installation and maintenance guidelines
23.9.2.4 Telephony voltages
782 23.9.3 Environment
23.9.3.1 Electromagnetic emission
23.9.3.2 Temperature and humidity
23.10 PHY labeling
23.11 Timing summary
23.11.1 Timing references
783 23.11.2 Definitions of controlled parameters
785 23.11.3 Table of required timing values
793 23.12 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 23, Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer, and baseband medium, type 100BASE-T4
23.12.1 Introduction
23.12.2 Identification
23.12.2.1 Implementation identification
23.12.2.2 Protocol summary
794 23.12.3 Major capabilities/options
23.12.4 PICS proforma tables for the Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer and baseband medium, type 100BASE-T4
23.12.4.1 Compatibility considerations
23.12.4.2 PCS Transmit functions
795 23.12.4.3 PCS Receive functions
23.12.4.4 Other PCS functions
796 23.12.4.5 PCS state diagram variables
797 23.12.4.6 PMA service interface
23.12.4.7 PMA Transmit functions
798 23.12.4.8 PMA Receive functions
23.12.4.9 Link Integrity functions
799 23.12.4.10 PMA Align functions
23.12.4.11 Other PMA functions
800 23.12.4.12 Isolation requirements
23.12.4.13 PMA electrical requirements
803 23.12.4.14 Characteristics of the link segment
804 23.12.4.15 MDI requirements
805 23.12.4.16 General safety and environmental requirements
806 23.12.4.17 Timing requirements
808 24. Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) and Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer, type 100BASE-X
24.1 Overview
24.1.1 Scope
24.1.2 Objectives
24.1.3 Relationship of 100BASE-X to other standards
809 24.1.4 Summary of 100BASE-X sublayers
24.1.4.1 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
810 24.1.4.2 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
24.1.4.3 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer
24.1.5 Inter-sublayer interfaces
24.1.6 Functional block diagram
24.1.7 State diagram conventions
813 24.2 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
24.2.1 Service Interface (MII)
24.2.2 Functional requirements
24.2.2.1 Code-groups
814 24.2.2.1.1 Data code-groups
24.2.2.1.2 Idle code-groups
24.2.2.1.3 Control code-groups
24.2.2.1.4 Start-of-Stream delimiter (/J/K/)
24.2.2.1.5 End-of-Stream delimiter (/T/R/)
816 24.2.2.1.6 Invalid code-groups
24.2.2.2 Encapsulation
817 24.2.2.3 Data delay
24.2.2.4 Mapping between MII and PMA
818 24.2.3 State variables
24.2.3.1 Constants
24.2.3.2 Variables
820 24.2.3.3 Functions
24.2.3.4 Timers
24.2.3.5 Messages
24.2.4 State diagrams
24.2.4.1 Transmit Bits
24.2.4.2 Transmit
821 24.2.4.3 Receive Bits
822 24.2.4.4 Receive
823 24.2.4.4.1 Detecting channel activity
24.2.4.4.2 Code-group alignment
24.2.4.4.3 Stream decoding
24.2.4.4.4 Stream termination
826 24.2.4.5 Carrier Sense
24.3 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
24.3.1 Service interface
24.3.1.1 PMA_TYPE.indicate
827 24.3.1.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
24.3.1.1.2 When generated
24.3.1.1.3 Effect of receipt
24.3.1.2 PMA_UNITDATA.request
24.3.1.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
24.3.1.2.2 When generated
24.3.1.2.3 Effect of receipt
24.3.1.3 PMA_UNITDATA.indicate
24.3.1.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
24.3.1.3.2 When generated
24.3.1.3.3 Effect of receipt
828 24.3.1.4 PMA_CARRIER.indicate
24.3.1.4.1 Semantics of the service primitive
24.3.1.4.2 When generated
24.3.1.4.3 Effect of receipt
24.3.1.5 PMA_LINK.indicate
24.3.1.5.1 Semantics of the service primitive
24.3.1.5.2 When generated
24.3.1.5.3 Effect of receipt
24.3.1.6 PMA_LINK.request
24.3.1.6.1 Semantics of the service primitive
829 24.3.1.6.2 When generated
24.3.1.6.3 Effect of receipt
24.3.1.7 PMA_RXERROR.indicate
24.3.1.7.1 Semantics of the service primitive
24.3.1.7.2 When generated
24.3.1.7.3 Effect of receipt
24.3.2 Functional requirements
830 24.3.2.1 Far-End fault
24.3.2.2 Comparison to previous IEEE 802.3 PMAs
831 24.3.3 State variables
24.3.3.1 Constants
24.3.3.2 Variables
832 24.3.3.3 Functions
24.3.3.4 Timers
24.3.3.5 Counters
833 24.3.3.6 Messages
24.3.4 Process specifications and state diagrams
24.3.4.1 TX
24.3.4.2 RX
24.3.4.3 Carrier detect
835 24.3.4.4 Link Monitor
24.3.4.5 Far-End Fault Generate
836 24.3.4.6 Far-End Fault Detect
837 24.4 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer service interface
24.4.1 PMD service interface
838 24.4.1.1 PMD_UNITDATA.request
24.4.1.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
24.4.1.1.2 When generated
24.4.1.1.3 Effect of receipt
24.4.1.2 PMD_UNITDATA.indicate
24.4.1.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
24.4.1.2.2 When generated
839 24.4.1.2.3 Effect of receipt
24.4.1.3 PMD_SIGNAL.indicate
24.4.1.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
24.4.1.3.2 When generated
24.4.1.3.3 Effect of receipt
24.4.2 Medium Dependent Interface (MDI)
24.5 Compatibility considerations
24.6 Delay constraints
840 24.6.1 PHY delay constraints (exposed MII)
24.6.2 DTE delay constraints (unexposed MII)
841 24.6.3 Carrier de-assertion/assertion constraint (half duplex mode only)
24.7 Environmental specifications
842 24.8 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 24, Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) and Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer, type 100BASE-X
24.8.1 Introduction
24.8.2 Identification
24.8.2.1 Implementation identification
24.8.2.2 Protocol summary
843 24.8.2.3 Major capabilities/options
24.8.3 PICS proforma tables for the Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) and Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer, type 100BASE-X
24.8.3.1 General compatibility considerations
24.8.3.2 PCS functions
844 24.8.3.3 PMA functions
24.8.3.4 Timing
846 25. Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 100BASE-TX
25.1 Overview
25.2 Functional specifications
25.3 General exceptions
847 25.4 Specific requirements and exceptions
25.4.1 Change to 7.2.3.1.1, “Line state patterns”
25.4.2 Change to 7.2.3.3, “Loss of synchronization”
848 25.4.3 Change to Table 8-1, “Contact assignments for unshielded twisted pair”
25.4.4 Deletion of 8.3, “Station labelling”
25.4.5 Replacement of 8.4.1, “UTP isolation requirements”
25.4.6 Change to 9.1.9, “Jitter”
849 25.4.7 UTP cable plant
25.4.7.1 Cabling system characteristics
25.4.7.2 Link transmission parameters
25.4.7.2.1 Insertion loss
25.4.7.2.2 Differential characteristic impedance
25.4.7.2.3 Return loss
850 25.4.7.2.4 Differential near-end crosstalk (NEXT)
25.4.7.3 Noise environment
25.4.7.3.1 External coupled noise
25.4.8 Replacement of 11.2, “Crossover function”
25.4.9 Change to A.2, “DDJ test pattern for baseline wander measurements”
25.4.10 Change to Annex G, “Stream cipher scrambling function”
25.4.11 Change to Annex I, “Common mode cable termination”
851 25.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 25, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 100BASE-TX
25.5.1 Introduction
25.5.2 Identification
25.5.2.1 Implementation identification
25.5.2.2 Protocol summary
852 25.5.3 Major capabilities/options
25.5.4 PICS proforma tables for the Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 100BASE-TX
25.5.4.1 General compatibility considerations
25.5.4.2 PMD compliance
853 25.5.4.3 Characteristics of link segment
854 26. Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 100BASE-FX
26.1 Overview
26.2 Functional specifications
26.3 General exceptions
855 26.4 Specific requirements and exceptions
26.4.1 Medium Dependent Interface (MDI)
26.4.2 Crossover function
856 26.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 26, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 100BASE-FX
26.5.1 Introduction
26.5.2 Identification
26.5.2.1 Implementation identification
26.5.3 Protocol summary
857 26.5.4 Major capabilities/options
26.5.5 PICS proforma tables for Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 100BASE-FX
26.5.5.1 General compatibility considerations
26.5.5.2 PMD compliance
858 27. Repeater for 100 Mb/s baseband networks
27.1 Overview
27.1.1 Scope
27.1.1.1 Repeater set
859 27.1.1.2 Repeater unit
27.1.1.3 Repeater classes
27.1.2 Application perspective
27.1.2.1 Objectives
27.1.2.2 Compatibility considerations
860 27.1.2.2.1 Internal segment compatibility
27.1.3 Relationship to PHY
27.2 PMA interface messages
27.3 Repeater functional specifications
861 27.3.1 Repeater functions
27.3.1.1 Signal restoration functional requirements
27.3.1.1.1 Signal amplification
27.3.1.1.2 Signal wave-shape restoration
27.3.1.1.3 Signal retiming
27.3.1.2 Data handling functional requirements
27.3.1.2.1 Data frame forwarding
27.3.1.2.2 Received code violations
862 27.3.1.3 Received event handling functional requirements
27.3.1.3.1 Received event handling
27.3.1.3.2 Preamble regeneration
27.3.1.3.3 Start-of-packet propagation delay
27.3.1.3.4 Start-of-packet variability
27.3.1.4 Collision handling functional requirements
27.3.1.4.1 Collision detection
27.3.1.4.2 Jam generation
863 27.3.1.4.3 Collision-jam propagation delay
27.3.1.4.4 Cessation-of-collision Jam propagation delay
27.3.1.5 Error handling functional requirements
27.3.1.5.1 100BASE-X and 100BASE-T2 carrier integrity functional requirements
864 27.3.1.5.2 Speed handling
27.3.1.6 Partition functional requirements
865 27.3.1.7 Receive jabber functional requirements
27.3.2 Detailed repeater functions and state diagrams
27.3.2.1 State diagram variables
27.3.2.1.1 Constants
866 27.3.2.1.2 Variables
869 27.3.2.1.3 Functions
27.3.2.1.4 Timers
870 27.3.2.1.5 Counters
27.3.2.1.6 Port designation
871 27.3.2.2 State diagrams
879 27.4 Repeater electrical specifications
27.4.1 Electrical isolation
27.5 Environmental specifications
27.5.1 General safety
27.5.2 Network safety
27.5.2.1 Installation
27.5.2.2 Grounding
880 27.5.2.3 Installation and maintenance guidelines
27.5.3 Electrical isolation
27.5.3.1 Environment A requirements
27.5.3.2 Environment B requirements
27.5.4 Reliability
881 27.5.5 Environment
27.5.5.1 Electromagnetic emission
27.5.5.2 Temperature and humidity
27.6 Repeater labeling
882 27.7 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 27, Repeater for 100 Mb/s baseband networks
27.7.1 Introduction
27.7.2 Identification
27.7.2.1 Implementation identification
27.7.2.2 Protocol summary
883 27.7.3 Major capabilities/options
27.7.4 PICS proforma tables for the repeater for 100 Mb/s baseband networks
27.7.4.1 Compatibility considerations
884 27.7.4.2 Repeater functions
27.7.4.3 Signal Restoration function
885 27.7.4.4 Data Handling function
27.7.4.5 Receive Event Handling function
886 27.7.4.6 Collision Handling function
887 27.7.4.7 Error Handling function
27.7.4.8 Partition functions
888 27.7.4.9 Receive Jabber function
889 27.7.4.10 Repeater state diagrams
27.7.4.11 Repeater electrical
890 27.7.4.12 Repeater labeling
892 28. Physical Layer link signaling for Auto-Negotiation on twisted pair
28.1 Overview
28.1.1 Scope
893 28.1.2 Application perspective/objectives
28.1.3 Relationship to ISO/IEC 8802-3
894 28.1.4 Compatibility considerations
895 28.1.4.1 Interoperability with existing 10BASE-T devices
28.1.4.2 Interoperability with Auto-Negotiation compatible devices
28.1.4.3 Cabling compatibility with Auto-Negotiation
28.2 Functional specifications
896 28.2.1 Transmit function requirements
28.2.1.1 Link pulse transmission
28.2.1.1.1 FLP burst encoding
897 28.2.1.1.2 Transmit timing
898 28.2.1.2 Link codeword encoding
28.2.1.2.1 Selector Field
28.2.1.2.2 Technology Ability Field
899 28.2.1.2.3 Extended next page
28.2.1.2.4 Remote Fault
28.2.1.2.5 Acknowledge
28.2.1.2.6 Next page
900 28.2.1.3 Transmit Switch function
28.2.2 Receive function requirements
28.2.2.1 FLP Burst ability detection and decoding
901 28.2.2.2 NLP detection
28.2.2.3 Receive Switch function
902 28.2.2.4 Link codeword matching
28.2.3 Arbitration function requirements
28.2.3.1 Parallel detection function
28.2.3.2 Renegotiation function
903 28.2.3.3 Priority Resolution function
28.2.3.4 Next Page function
904 28.2.3.4.1 Next page encodings
905 28.2.3.4.2 Extended next page encodings
28.2.3.4.3 Next Page
906 28.2.3.4.4 Acknowledge
28.2.3.4.5 Message Page
28.2.3.4.6 Acknowledge 2
28.2.3.4.7 Toggle
28.2.3.4.8 Message Page encoding
28.2.3.4.9 Message Code Field
28.2.3.4.10 Unformatted Page encoding
907 28.2.3.4.11 Unformatted Code Field
28.2.3.4.12 Extended Unformatted Code Field
28.2.3.4.13 Use of next pages
28.2.3.4.14 MII register requirements
28.2.3.5 Remote fault sensing function
908 28.2.4 Management function requirements
28.2.4.1 Media Independent Interface
28.2.4.1.1 MII control register
28.2.4.1.2 MII status register
909 28.2.4.1.3 Auto-Negotiation advertisement register (Register 4) (R/W)
28.2.4.1.4 Auto-Negotiation Link Partner ability register (Register 5) (RO)
910 28.2.4.1.5 Auto-Negotiation expansion register (Register 6) (RO)
912 28.2.4.1.6 Auto-Negotiation Next Page transmit register (Register 7) (R/W)
28.2.4.1.7 Auto-Negotiation Link Partner Received Next Page register (Register 8) (RO)
913 28.2.4.1.8 State diagram variable to MII register mapping
914 28.2.4.2 Auto-Negotiation managed object class
28.2.5 Absence of management function
28.2.6 Technology-Dependent Interface
28.2.6.1 PMA_LINK.indication
28.2.6.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
915 28.2.6.1.2 When generated
28.2.6.1.3 Effect of receipt
28.2.6.2 PMA_LINK.request
28.2.6.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
28.2.6.2.2 When generated
28.2.6.2.3 Effect of receipt
28.2.6.3 PMA_LINKPULSE.request
916 28.2.6.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
28.2.6.3.2 When generated
28.2.6.3.3 Effect of receipt
28.3 State diagrams and variable definitions
917 28.3.1 State diagram variables
923 28.3.2 State diagram timers
926 28.3.3 State diagram counters
927 28.3.4 State diagrams
930 28.4 Electrical specifications
931 28.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 28, Physical Layer link signaling for Auto-Negotiation on twisted pair
28.5.1 Introduction
28.5.2 Identification
28.5.2.1 Implementation identification
28.5.2.2 Protocol summary
932 28.5.3 Major capabilities/options
28.5.4 PICS proforma tables for Physical Layer link signaling for Auto-Negotiation on twisted pair
28.5.4.1 Scope
933 28.5.4.2 Auto-Negotiation functions
28.5.4.3 Transmit function requirements
935 28.5.4.4 Receive function requirements
936 28.5.4.5 Arbitration functions
938 28.5.4.6 Management function requirements
941 28.5.4.7 Technology-dependent interface
942 28.5.4.8 State diagrams
943 28.5.4.9 Electrical characteristics
28.5.4.10 Auto-Negotiation annexes
946 28.6 Auto-Negotiation expansion
948 29. System considerations for multisegment 100BASE-T networks
29.1 Overview
949 29.1.1 Single collision domain multisegment networks
950 29.1.2 Repeater usage
29.2 Transmission System Model 1
29.3 Transmission System Model 2
952 29.3.1 Round-trip collision delay
29.3.1.1 Worst-case path delay value (PDV) selection
29.3.1.2 Worst-case PDV calculation
955 29.4 Full duplex 100 Mb/s topology limitations
956 30. Management
30.1 Overview
957 30.1.1 Scope
30.1.2 Relationship to objects in IEEE 802.1F
958 30.1.3 Systems management overview
30.1.4 Management model
959 30.2 Managed objects
30.2.1 Introduction
30.2.2 Overview of managed objects
30.2.2.1 Text description of managed objects
962 30.2.2.2 Functions to support management
30.2.2.2.1 DTE MAC sublayer functions
963 30.2.2.2.2 Repeater functions
965 30.2.3 Containment
30.2.4 Naming
30.2.5 Capabilities
984 30.3 Layer management for DTEs
30.3.1 MAC entity managed object class
985 30.3.1.1 MAC entity attributes
30.3.1.1.1 aMACID
30.3.1.1.2 aFramesTransmittedOK
30.3.1.1.3 aSingleCollisionFrames
30.3.1.1.4 aMultipleCollisionFrames
986 30.3.1.1.5 aFramesReceivedOK
30.3.1.1.6 aFrameCheckSequenceErrors
30.3.1.1.7 aAlignmentErrors
30.3.1.1.8 aOctetsTransmittedOK
987 30.3.1.1.9 aFramesWithDeferredXmissions
30.3.1.1.10 aLateCollisions
30.3.1.1.11 aFramesAbortedDueToXSColls
30.3.1.1.12 aFramesLostDueToIntMACXmitError
988 30.3.1.1.13 aCarrierSenseErrors
30.3.1.1.14 aOctetsReceivedOK
30.3.1.1.15 aFramesLostDueToIntMACRcvError
30.3.1.1.16 aPromiscuousStatus
989 30.3.1.1.17 aReadMulticastAddressList
30.3.1.1.18 aMulticastFramesXmittedOK
30.3.1.1.19 aBroadcastFramesXmittedOK
990 30.3.1.1.20 aFramesWithExcessiveDeferral
30.3.1.1.21 aMulticastFramesReceivedOK
30.3.1.1.22 aBroadcastFramesReceivedOK
30.3.1.1.23 aInRangeLengthErrors
991 30.3.1.1.24 aOutOfRangeLengthField
30.3.1.1.25 aFrameTooLongErrors
30.3.1.1.26 aMACEnableStatus
992 30.3.1.1.27 aTransmitEnableStatus
30.3.1.1.28 aMulticastReceiveStatus
30.3.1.1.29 aReadWriteMACAddress
30.3.1.1.30 aCollisionFrames
993 30.3.1.1.31 aMACCapabilities
30.3.1.1.32 aDuplexStatus
30.3.1.1.33 aRateControlAbility
30.3.1.1.34 aRateControlStatus
994 30.3.1.1.35 aDeferControlAbility
30.3.1.1.36 aDeferControlStatus
30.3.1.1.37 aMaxFrameLength
30.3.1.2 MAC entity actions
30.3.1.2.1 acInitializeMAC
995 30.3.1.2.2 acAddGroupAddress
30.3.1.2.3 acDeleteGroupAddress
30.3.1.2.4 acExecuteSelfTest
30.3.2 PHY devicePHY device managed object class
30.3.2.1 PHY device attributes
30.3.2.1.1 aPHYID
996 30.3.2.1.2 aPhyType
30.3.2.1.3 aPhyTypeList
997 30.3.2.1.4 aSQETestErrors
30.3.2.1.5 aSymbolErrorDuringCarrier
30.3.2.1.6 aMIIDetect
998 30.3.2.1.7 aPhyAdminState
30.3.2.2 PHY device actions
30.3.2.2.1 acPhyAdminControl
30.3.3 MAC control entity object class
30.3.3.1 aMACControlID
999 30.3.3.2 aMACControlFunctionsSupported
30.3.3.3 aMACControlFramesTransmitted
30.3.3.4 aMACControlFramesReceived
30.3.3.5 aUnsupportedOpcodesReceived
1000 30.3.4 PAUSE entity managed object class
30.3.4.1 aPAUSELinkDelayAllowance
30.3.4.2 aPAUSEMACCtrlFramesTransmitted
30.3.4.3 aPAUSEMACCtrlFramesReceived
30.3.5 MPCP managed object class
30.3.5.1 MPCP Attributes
30.3.5.1.1 aMPCPID
1001 30.3.5.1.2 aMPCPAdminState
30.3.5.1.3 aMPCPMode
30.3.5.1.4 aMPCPLinkID
30.3.5.1.5 aMPCPRemoteMACAddress
1002 30.3.5.1.6 aMPCPRegistrationState
30.3.5.1.7 aMPCPMACCtrlFramesTransmitted
30.3.5.1.8 aMPCPMACCtrlFramesReceived
1003 30.3.5.1.9 aMPCPTxGate
30.3.5.1.10 aMPCPTxRegAck
30.3.5.1.11 aMPCPTxRegister
30.3.5.1.12 aMPCPTxRegRequest
1004 30.3.5.1.13 aMPCPTxReport
30.3.5.1.14 aMPCPRxGate
30.3.5.1.15 aMPCPRxRegAck
30.3.5.1.16 aMPCPRxRegister
1005 30.3.5.1.17 aMPCPRxRegRequest
30.3.5.1.18 aMPCPRxReport
30.3.5.1.19 aMPCPTransmitElapsed
30.3.5.1.20 aMPCPReceiveElapsed
1006 30.3.5.1.21 aMPCPRoundTripTime
30.3.5.1.22 aMPCPDiscoveryWindowsSent
30.3.5.1.23 aMPCPDiscoveryTimeout
30.3.5.1.24 aMPCPMaximumPendingGrants
30.3.5.2 MPCP Actions
30.3.5.2.1 acMPCPAdminControl
1007 30.3.6 OAM object class
30.3.6.1 OAM Attributes
30.3.6.1.1 aOAMID
30.3.6.1.2 aOAMAdminState
30.3.6.1.3 aOAMMode
30.3.6.1.4 aOAMDiscoveryState
1008 30.3.6.1.5 aOAMRemoteMACAddress
30.3.6.1.6 aOAMLocalConfiguration
30.3.6.1.7 aOAMRemoteConfiguration
1009 30.3.6.1.8 aOAMLocalPDUConfiguration
30.3.6.1.9 aOAMRemotePDUConfiguration
30.3.6.1.10 aOAMLocalFlagsField
1010 30.3.6.1.11 aOAMRemoteFlagsField
30.3.6.1.12 aOAMLocalRevision
30.3.6.1.13 aOAMRemoteRevision
1011 30.3.6.1.14 aOAMLocalState
30.3.6.1.15 aOAMRemoteState
30.3.6.1.16 aOAMRemoteVendorOUI
30.3.6.1.17 aOAMRemoteVendorSpecificInfo
1012 30.3.6.1.18 aOAMUnsupportedCodesTx
30.3.6.1.19 aOAMUnsupportedCodesRx
30.3.6.1.20 aOAMInformationTx
30.3.6.1.21 aOAMInformationRx
1013 30.3.6.1.22 aOAMUniqueEventNotificationTx
30.3.6.1.23 aOAMDuplicateEventNotificationTx
30.3.6.1.24 aOAMUniqueEventNotificationRx
1014 30.3.6.1.25 aOAMDuplicateEventNotificationRx
30.3.6.1.26 aOAMLoopbackControlTx
30.3.6.1.27 aOAMLoopbackControlRx
1015 30.3.6.1.28 aOAMVariableRequestTx
30.3.6.1.29 aOAMVariableRequestRx
30.3.6.1.30 aOAMVariableResponseTx
30.3.6.1.31 aOAMVariableResponseRx
1016 30.3.6.1.32 aOAMOrganizationSpecificTx
30.3.6.1.33 aOAMOrganizationSpecificRx
30.3.6.1.34 aOAMLocalErrSymPeriodConfig
30.3.6.1.35 aOAMLocalErrSymPeriodEvent
1017 30.3.6.1.36 aOAMLocalErrFrameConfig
30.3.6.1.37 aOAMLocalErrFrameEvent
30.3.6.1.38 aOAMLocalErrFramePeriodConfig
30.3.6.1.39 aOAMLocalErrFramePeriodEvent
1018 30.3.6.1.40 aOAMLocalErrFrameSecsSummaryConfig
30.3.6.1.41 aOAMLocalErrFrameSecsSummaryEvent
30.3.6.1.42 aOAMRemoteErrSymPeriodEvent
1019 30.3.6.1.43 aOAMRemoteErrFrameEvent
30.3.6.1.44 aOAMRemoteErrFramePeriodEvent
1020 30.3.6.1.45 aOAMRemoteErrFrameSecsSummaryEvent
30.3.6.1.46 aFramesLostDueToOAMError
1021 30.3.6.2 OAM Actions
30.3.6.2.1 acOAMAdminControl
30.3.7 OMPEmulation managed object class
30.3.7.1 OMPEmulation Attributes
30.3.7.1.1 aOMPEmulationID
30.3.7.1.2 aOMPEmulationType
30.3.7.1.3 aSLDErrors
30.3.7.1.4 aCRC8Errors
1022 30.3.7.1.5 aGoodLLID
30.3.7.1.6 aONUPONcastLLID
30.3.7.1.7 aOLTPONcastLLID
30.3.7.1.8 aBadLLID
1023 30.4 Layer management for 10, 100, and 1000 Mb/s baseband repeaters
30.4.1 Repeater managed object class
30.4.1.1 Repeater attributes
30.4.1.1.1 aRepeaterID
30.4.1.1.2 aRepeaterType
30.4.1.1.3 aRepeaterGroupCapacity
1024 30.4.1.1.4 aGroupMap
30.4.1.1.5 aRepeaterHealthState
30.4.1.1.6 aRepeaterHealthText
30.4.1.1.7 aRepeaterHealthData
1025 30.4.1.1.8 aTransmitCollisions
30.4.1.2 Repeater actions
30.4.1.2.1 acResetRepeater
30.4.1.2.2 acExecuteNonDisruptiveSelfTest
1026 30.4.1.3 Repeater notifications
30.4.1.3.1 nRepeaterHealth
30.4.1.3.2 nRepeaterReset
30.4.1.3.3 nGroupMapChange
1027 30.4.2 Group managed object class
30.4.2.1 Group attributes
30.4.2.1.1 aGroupID
30.4.2.1.2 aGroupPortCapacity
30.4.2.1.3 aPortMap
30.4.2.2 Group notifications
30.4.2.2.1 nPortMapChange
1028 30.4.3 Repeater port managed object class
30.4.3.1 Port attributes
30.4.3.1.1 aPortID
30.4.3.1.2 aPortAdminState
30.4.3.1.3 aAutoPartitionState
1029 30.4.3.1.4 aReadableFrames
30.4.3.1.5 aReadableOctets
30.4.3.1.6 aFrameCheckSequenceErrors
30.4.3.1.7 aAlignmentErrors
1030 30.4.3.1.8 aFramesTooLong
30.4.3.1.9 aShortEvents
30.4.3.1.10 aRunts
1031 30.4.3.1.11 aCollisions
30.4.3.1.12 aLateEvents
1032 30.4.3.1.13 aVeryLongEvents
30.4.3.1.14 aDataRateMismatches
30.4.3.1.15 aAutoPartitions
1033 30.4.3.1.16 aIsolates
30.4.3.1.17 aSymbolErrorDuringPacket
30.4.3.1.18 aLastSourceAddress
30.4.3.1.19 aSourceAddressChanges
1034 30.4.3.1.20 aBursts
30.4.3.2 Port actions
30.4.3.2.1 acPortAdminControl
30.5 Layer management for medium attachment units (MAUs)
30.5.1 MAU managed object class
30.5.1.1 MAU attributes
30.5.1.1.1 aMAUID
1035 30.5.1.1.2 aMAUType
1037 30.5.1.1.3 aMAUTypeList
30.5.1.1.4 aMediaAvailable
1038 30.5.1.1.5 aLoseMediaCounter
1039 30.5.1.1.6 aJabber
30.5.1.1.7 aMAUAdminState
30.5.1.1.8 aBbMAUXmitRcvSplitType
1040 30.5.1.1.9 aBroadbandFrequencies
30.5.1.1.10 aFalseCarriers
30.5.1.1.11 aIdleErrorCount
30.5.1.1.12 aPCSCodingViolation
1041 30.5.1.1.13 aFECAbility
30.5.1.1.14 aFECmode
30.5.1.1.15 aFECCorrectedBlocks
1042 30.5.1.1.16 aFECUncorrectableBlocks
30.5.1.1.17 aSNROpMarginChnlA
30.5.1.1.18 aSNROpMarginChnlB
1043 30.5.1.1.19 aSNROpMarginChnlC
30.5.1.1.20 aSNROpMarginChnlD
30.5.1.2 MAU actions
30.5.1.2.1 acResetMAU
30.5.1.2.2 acMAUAdminControl
30.5.1.3 MAU notifications
30.5.1.3.1 nJabber
1044 30.6 Management for link Auto-Negotiation
30.6.1 Auto-Negotiation managed object class
30.6.1.1 Auto-Negotiation attributes
30.6.1.1.1 aAutoNegID
30.6.1.1.2 aAutoNegAdminState
30.6.1.1.3 aAutoNegRemoteSignaling
1045 30.6.1.1.4 aAutoNegAutoConfig
30.6.1.1.5 aAutoNegLocalTechnologyAbility
1046 30.6.1.1.6 aAutoNegAdvertisedTechnologyAbility
30.6.1.1.7 aAutoNegReceivedTechnologyAbility
30.6.1.1.8 aAutoNegLocalSelectorAbility
1047 30.6.1.1.9 aAutoNegAdvertisedSelectorAbility
30.6.1.1.10 aAutoNegReceivedSelectorAbility
30.6.1.2 Auto-Negotiation actions
30.6.1.2.1 acAutoNegRestartAutoConfig
30.6.1.2.2 acAutoNegAdminControl
1048 30.7 Management for Link Aggregation
30.7.1 Aggregator managed object class
30.7.1.1 Aggregator attributes
30.7.1.1.1 aAggID
1049 30.7.1.1.2 aAggDescription
30.7.1.1.3 aAggName
30.7.1.1.4 aAggActorSystemID
1050 30.7.1.1.5 aAggActorSystemPriority
30.7.1.1.6 aAggAggregateOrIndividual
30.7.1.1.7 aAggActorAdminKey
30.7.1.1.8 aAggActorOperKey
1051 30.7.1.1.9 aAggMACAddress
30.7.1.1.10 aAggPartnerSystemID
30.7.1.1.11 aAggPartnerSystemPriority
30.7.1.1.12 aAggPartnerOperKey
1052 30.7.1.1.13 aAggAdminState
30.7.1.1.14 aAggOperState
30.7.1.1.15 aAggTimeOfLastOperChange
1053 30.7.1.1.16 aAggDataRate
30.7.1.1.17 aAggOctetsTxOK
30.7.1.1.18 aAggOctetsRxOK
30.7.1.1.19 aAggFramesTxOK
1054 30.7.1.1.20 aAggFramesRxOK
30.7.1.1.21 aAggMulticastFramesTxOK
30.7.1.1.22 aAggMulticastFramesRxOK
1055 30.7.1.1.23 aAggBroadcastFramesTxOK
1056 30.7.1.1.24 aAggBroadcastFramesRxOK
30.7.1.1.25 aAggFramesDiscardedOnTx
1057 30.7.1.1.26 aAggFramesDiscardedOnRx
30.7.1.1.27 aAggFramesWithTxErrors
30.7.1.1.28 aAggFramesWithRxErrors
30.7.1.1.29 aAggUnknownProtocolFrames
1058 30.7.1.1.30 aAggPortList
30.7.1.1.31 aAggLinkUpDownNotificationEnable
30.7.1.1.32 aAggCollectorMaxDelay
1059 30.7.1.2 Aggregator Notifications
30.7.1.2.1 nAggLinkUpNotification
30.7.1.2.2 nAggLinkDownNotification
30.7.2 Aggregation Port managed object class
30.7.2.1 Aggregation Port Attributes
30.7.2.1.1 aAggPortID
1060 30.7.2.1.2 aAggPortActorSystemPriority
30.7.2.1.3 aAggPortActorSystemID
30.7.2.1.4 aAggPortActorAdminKey
30.7.2.1.5 aAggPortActorOperKey
1061 30.7.2.1.6 aAggPortPartnerAdminSystemPriority
30.7.2.1.7 aAggPortPartnerOperSystemPriority
30.7.2.1.8 aAggPortPartnerAdminSystemID
30.7.2.1.9 aAggPortPartnerOperSystemID
1062 30.7.2.1.10 aAggPortPartnerAdminKey
30.7.2.1.11 aAggPortPartnerOperKey
30.7.2.1.12 aAggPortSelectedAggID
30.7.2.1.13 aAggPortAttachedAggID
1063 30.7.2.1.14 aAggPortActorPort
30.7.2.1.15 aAggPortActorPortPriority
30.7.2.1.16 aAggPortPartnerAdminPort
30.7.2.1.17 aAggPortPartnerOperPort
1064 30.7.2.1.18 aAggPortPartnerAdminPortPriority
30.7.2.1.19 aAggPortPartnerOperPortPriority
30.7.2.1.20 aAggPortActorAdminState
1065 30.7.2.1.21 aAggPortActorOperState
30.7.2.1.22 aAggPortPartnerAdminState
30.7.2.1.23 aAggPortPartnerOperState
30.7.2.1.24 aAggPortAggregateOrIndividual
1066 30.7.3 Aggregation Port Statistics managed object class
30.7.3.1 Aggregation Port Statistics attributes
30.7.3.1.1 aAggPortStatsID
30.7.3.1.2 aAggPortStatsLACPDUsRx
30.7.3.1.3 aAggPortStatsMarkerPDUsRx
1067 30.7.3.1.4 aAggPortStatsMarkerResponsePDUsRx
30.7.3.1.5 aAggPortStatsUnknownRx
30.7.3.1.6 aAggPortStatsIllegalRx
30.7.3.1.7 aAggPortStatsLACPDUsTx
1068 30.7.3.1.8 aAggPortStatsMarkerPDUsTx
30.7.3.1.9 aAggPortStatsMarkerResponsePDUsTx
30.7.4 Aggregation Port Debug Information managed object class
30.7.4.1 Aggregation Port Debug Information attributes
30.7.4.1.1 aAggPortDebugInformationID
1069 30.7.4.1.2 aAggPortDebugRxState
30.7.4.1.3 aAggPortDebugLastRxTime
30.7.4.1.4 aAggPortDebugMuxState
1070 30.7.4.1.5 aAggPortDebugMuxReason
30.7.4.1.6 aAggPortDebugActorChurnState
30.7.4.1.7 aAggPortDebugPartnerChurnState
1071 30.7.4.1.8 aAggPortDebugActorChurnCount
30.7.4.1.9 aAggPortDebugPartnerChurnCount
30.7.4.1.10 aAggPortDebugActorSyncTransitionCount
1072 30.7.4.1.11 aAggPortDebugPartnerSyncTransitionCount
30.7.4.1.12 aAggPortDebugActorChangeCount
30.7.4.1.13 aAggPortDebugPartnerChangeCount
30.8 Management for WAN Interface Sublayer (WIS)
30.8.1 WIS managed object class
30.8.1.1 WIS attributes
1073 30.8.1.1.1 aWISID
30.8.1.1.2 aSectionStatus
30.8.1.1.3 aSectionSESThreshold
30.8.1.1.4 aSectionSESs
30.8.1.1.5 aSectionESs
1074 30.8.1.1.6 aSectionSEFSs
30.8.1.1.7 aSectionCVs
30.8.1.1.8 aJ0ValueTX
30.8.1.1.9 aJ0ValueRX
1075 30.8.1.1.10 aLineStatus
30.8.1.1.11 aLineSESThreshold
30.8.1.1.12 aLineSESs
30.8.1.1.13 aLineESs
30.8.1.1.14 aLineCVs
1076 30.8.1.1.15 aFarEndLineSESs
30.8.1.1.16 aFarEndLineESs
30.8.1.1.17 aFarEndLineCVs
30.8.1.1.18 aPathStatus
1077 30.8.1.1.19 aPathSESThreshold
30.8.1.1.20 aPathSESs
30.8.1.1.21 aPathESs
30.8.1.1.22 aPathCVs
30.8.1.1.23 aJ1ValueTX
1078 30.8.1.1.24 aJ1ValueRX
30.8.1.1.25 aFarEndPathStatus
30.8.1.1.26 aFarEndPathSESs
30.8.1.1.27 aFarEndPathESs
1079 30.8.1.1.28 aFarEndPathCVs
30.9 Management for Power Sourcing Equipment (PSE)
30.9.1 PSE managed object class
30.9.1.1 PSE attributes
30.9.1.1.1 aPSEID
30.9.1.1.2 aPSEAdminState
30.9.1.1.3 aPSEPowerPairsControlAbility
1080 30.9.1.1.4 aPSEPowerPairs
30.9.1.1.5 aPSEPowerDetectionStatus
1081 30.9.1.1.6 aPSEPowerClassification
30.9.1.1.7 aPSEInvalidSignatureCounter
30.9.1.1.8 aPSEPowerDeniedCounter
30.9.1.1.9 aPSEOverLoadCounter
1082 30.9.1.1.10 aPSEShortCounter
30.9.1.1.11 aPSEMPSAbsentCounter
30.9.1.2 PSE actions
30.9.1.2.1 acPSEAdminControl
30.10 Layer management for Midspan
30.10.1 Midspan managed object class
30.10.1.1 Midspan attributes
30.10.1.1.1 aMidSpanID
1083 30.10.1.1.2 aMidSpanPSEGroupCapacity
30.10.1.1.3 aMidSpanPSEGroupMap
30.10.1.2 Midspan notifications
30.10.1.2.1 nMidSpanPSEGroupMapChange
30.10.2 PSE Group managed object class
30.10.2.1 PSE Group attributes
30.10.2.1.1 aPSEGroupID
1084 30.10.2.1.2 aPSECapacity
30.10.2.1.3 aPSEMap
30.10.2.2 PSE Group notifications
30.10.2.2.1 nPSEMapChange
30.11 Layer Management for Physical Medium Entity (PME)
30.11.1 PAF managed object class
1085 30.11.1.1 PAFAttributes
30.11.1.1.1 aPAFID
30.11.1.1.2 aPhyEnd
30.11.1.1.3 aPHYCurrentStatus
1086 30.11.1.1.4 aPAFSupported
30.11.1.1.5 aPAFAdminState
30.11.1.1.6 aLocalPAFCapacity
30.11.1.1.7 aLocalPMEAvailable
1087 30.11.1.1.8 aLocalPMEAggregate
30.11.1.1.9 aRemotePAFSupported
30.11.1.1.10 aRemotePAFCapacity
1088 30.11.1.1.11 aRemotePMEAggregate
30.11.2 PME managed object class
30.11.2.1 PME Attributes
30.11.2.1.1 aPMEID
30.11.2.1.2 aPMEAdminState
30.11.2.1.3 aPMEStatus
1089 30.11.2.1.4 aPMESNRMgn
30.11.2.1.5 aTCCodingViolations
30.11.2.1.6 aProfileSelect
1090 30.11.2.1.7 aOperatingProfile
30.11.2.1.8 aPMEFECCorrectedBlocks
1091 30.11.2.1.9 aPMEFECUncorrectableBlocks
30.11.2.1.10 aTCCRCErrors
1092 31. MAC Control
31.1 Overview
31.2 Layer architecture
31.3 Support by interlayer interfaces
1094 31.3.1 MA_CONTROL.request
31.3.1.1 Function
31.3.1.2 Semantics of the service primitive
31.3.1.3 When generated
31.3.1.4 Effect of receipt
31.3.2 MA_CONTROL.indication
31.3.2.1 Function
31.3.2.2 Semantics of the service primitive
1095 31.3.2.3 When generated
31.3.2.4 Effect of receipt
31.4 MAC Control frames
31.4.1 MAC Control frame format
31.4.1.1 Destination Address field
1096 31.4.1.2 Source Address field
31.4.1.3 Length/Type field
31.4.1.4 MAC Control Opcode field
31.4.1.5 MAC Control Parameters field
31.4.1.6 Reserved field
31.5 Opcode-independent MAC Control sublayer operation
31.5.1 Frame parsing and data frame reception
1097 31.5.2 Control frame reception
31.5.3 Opcode-independent MAC Control receive state diagram
31.5.3.1 Constants
31.5.3.2 Variables
1098 31.5.3.3 Messages
1099 31.5.3.4 Opcode-independent MAC Control Receive state diagram
31.6 Compatibility requirements
31.7 MAC Control client behavior
1100 31.8 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 31, MAC Control
31.8.1 Introduction
31.8.2 Identification
31.8.2.1 Implementation identification
31.8.2.2 Protocol summary
1101 31.8.3 PICS proforma for MAC Control frames
31.8.3.1 Support by interlayer interfaces
31.8.3.2 MAC Control frame format
31.8.3.3 Opcode-independent MAC Control sublayer operation
31.8.3.4 Control opcode assignments
1102 32. Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer and baseband medium, type 100BASE-T2
32.1 Overview
32.1.1 Relation of 100BASE-T2 to other standards
32.1.2 Operation of 100BASE-T2
1106 32.1.2.1 Physical coding sublayer (PCS)
32.1.2.2 PMA sublayer
32.1.2.3 PHY Control function
1107 32.1.3 Application of 100BASE-T2
32.1.3.1 Compatibility considerations
32.1.3.2 Incorporating the 100BASE-T2 PHY into a DTE
32.1.3.3 Use of 100BASE-T2 PHY for point-to-point communication
32.1.3.4 Auto-Negotiation requirement
32.1.4 State diagram conventions
32.2 PHY Control functional specifications and service interface
32.2.1 PHY Control function
1108 32.2.2 PHY Control Service interface
32.2.2.1 PHYC_CONFIG.indication
32.2.2.1.1 Semantics of the primitive
1109 32.2.2.1.2 When generated
32.2.2.1.3 Effect of receipt
32.2.2.2 PHYC_TXMODE.indication
32.2.2.2.1 Semantics of the primitive
32.2.2.2.2 When generated
32.2.2.2.3 Effect of receipt
32.2.2.3 PHYC_RXSTATUS.request
32.2.2.3.1 Semantics of the primitive
1110 32.2.2.3.2 When generated
32.2.2.3.3 Effect of receipt
32.2.2.4 PHYC_REMRXSTATUS.request
32.2.2.4.1 Semantics of the primitive
32.2.2.4.2 When generated
32.2.2.4.3 Effect of receipt
32.2.3 State diagram variables
1111 32.2.4 State diagram timers
1112 32.2.5 PHY Control state diagram
32.3 PCS functional specifications
1114 32.3.1 PCS functions
32.3.1.1 PCS Reset function
32.3.1.2 PCS Transmit function
32.3.1.2.1 Side-stream scrambler polynomials
1115 32.3.1.2.2 Generation of bits San[2:0] and Sbn[2:0]
1116 32.3.1.2.3 Generation of sequences An and Bn
1119 32.3.1.3 PCS Receive function
32.3.1.3.1 Receiver descrambler polynomials
32.3.1.3.2 Decoding of quinary symbols
1120 32.3.1.4 PCS Carrier Sense function
32.3.1.5 PCS Collision Presence function
32.3.2 PCS interfaces
32.3.2.1 PCS–MII interface signals
32.3.2.2 PCS–management entity signals
1121 32.3.3 Frame structure
32.3.4 State variables
32.3.4.1 Variables
1123 32.3.4.2 Timer
32.3.4.3 Messages
32.3.5 State diagrams
32.3.5.1 PCS Transmit
32.3.5.2 PCS Receive
1124 32.3.5.3 PCS Carrier Sense
32.3.6 PCS electrical specifications
1127 32.4 PMA functional specifications and service interface
32.4.1 PMA functional specifications
1128 32.4.1.1 PMA functions
32.4.1.1.1 PMA Reset function
32.4.1.1.2 PMA Transmit function
32.4.1.1.3 PMA Receive function
32.4.1.1.4 Link Monitor function
1129 32.4.1.1.5 Clock Recovery function
32.4.1.2 PMA interface messages
32.4.1.2.1 MDI signals transmitted by the PHY
32.4.1.2.2 Signals received at the MDI
1130 32.4.1.3 PMA state diagram
32.4.1.3.1 State diagram variables
32.4.1.3.2 Timers
32.4.1.3.3 Link Monitor state diagram
1131 32.4.2 PMA service interface
32.4.2.1 PMA_TYPE.indication
32.4.2.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
32.4.2.1.2 When generated
32.4.2.1.3 Effect of receipt
32.4.2.2 PMA_UNITDATA.request
32.4.2.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
1132 32.4.2.2.2 When generated
32.4.2.2.3 Effect of receipt
32.4.2.3 PMA_UNITDATA.indication
32.4.2.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
32.4.2.3.2 When generated
32.4.2.3.3 Effect of receipt
32.4.2.4 PMA_LINK.request
32.4.2.4.1 Semantics of the service primitive
1133 32.4.2.4.2 When generated
32.4.2.4.3 Effect of receipt
32.4.2.5 PMA_LINK.indication
32.4.2.5.1 Semantics of the service primitive
32.4.2.5.2 When generated
32.4.2.5.3 Effect of receipt
32.4.2.6 PMA_CARRIER.indication
1134 32.4.2.7 PMA_RXERROR.indication
32.4.2.8 PMA_RXSTATUS.request
32.5 Management functions
32.5.1 100BASE-T2 Use of Auto-Negotiation and MII Registers 8, 9, and 10
1135 32.5.2 Management functions
1136 32.5.3 PHY specific registers for 100BASE-T2
32.5.3.1 100BASE-T2 Control register (Register 9)
32.5.3.1.1 Transmitter test mode
32.5.3.1.2 Receive test mode
1137 32.5.3.1.3 MASTER-SLAVE Manual Configuration Enable
32.5.3.1.4 MASTER-SLAVE Manual Configuration Value
32.5.3.1.5 T2_Repeater/DTE Bit
32.5.3.1.6 Reserved bits
32.5.3.2 100BASE-T2 Status register (Register 10)
1138 32.5.3.2.1 MASTER-SLAVE Manual Configuration Fault
32.5.3.2.2 MASTER-SLAVE Configuration Resolution Complete
32.5.3.2.3 Local Receiver Status
32.5.3.2.4 Remote Receiver Status
32.5.3.2.5 Reserved bits
32.5.3.2.6 Idle Error count
32.5.4 Changes and additions to Auto-Negotiation (Clause 28)
32.5.4.1 Change to 28.2.4.1.3 (Auto-Negotiation Advertisement register)
1139 32.5.4.2 Use of Auto-Negotiation Next Page codes for 100BASE-T2 PHYs
1140 32.5.4.3 MASTER-SLAVE Configuration Resolution
1141 32.6 PMA electrical specifications
32.6.1 PMA-to-MDI interface characteristics
32.6.1.1 Isolation requirement
32.6.1.2 Transmitter electrical specifications
1142 32.6.1.2.1 Transmitter test modes
32.6.1.2.2 Peak differential output voltage and level distortion
1144 32.6.1.2.3 Maximum output droop
32.6.1.2.4 Differential output templates
1148 32.6.1.2.5 Transmitter timing jitter
32.6.1.2.6 Transmit clock frequency
32.6.1.3 Receiver electrical specifications
1149 32.6.1.3.1 Test channel
1160 32.6.1.3.2 Receiver test mode
32.6.1.3.3 Receiver differential input signals
1161 32.6.1.3.4 Receiver Alien NEXT tolerance
32.6.1.3.5 Receiver timing jitter
32.6.1.3.6 Common-mode noise rejection
1162 32.6.1.3.7 Receiver frequency tolerance
32.6.1.4 MDI Specifications
32.6.1.4.1 MDI differential impedance
32.6.1.4.2 MDI impedance balance
1163 32.6.1.4.3 MDI common-mode output voltage
32.6.1.4.4 MDI fault tolerance
1164 32.6.2 Power consumption
32.7 Link segment characteristics
32.7.1 Cabling
1165 32.7.2 Link transmission parameters
32.7.2.1 Insertion loss
32.7.2.2 Differential characteristic impedance
32.7.2.3 Coupling parameters
32.7.2.3.1 Differential near-end crosstalk (NEXT) loss
1166 32.7.2.3.2 Multiple-disturber NEXT (MDNEXT) loss
32.7.2.3.3 Equal level far-end crosstalk loss (ELFEXT)
32.7.2.3.4 Multiple-disturber ELFEXT (MDELFEXT) loss
32.7.2.3.5 10BASE-T NEXT loss to insertion loss ratio requirement
1167 32.7.2.4 Delay
32.7.2.4.1 Maximum link delay
32.7.2.4.2 Difference in link delays
32.7.3 Noise
1168 32.7.3.1 Near-end crosstalk noise
1169 32.7.3.2 Far-end crosstalk noise
32.7.3.3 External coupled noise
32.7.4 Installation practice
32.7.4.1 Connector installation practices
32.7.4.2 Restrictions on use of Category 3 cabling with more than four pairs
32.7.4.3 Restrictions on use of Category 5 cabling with up to 25 pairs
1170 32.8 MDI specification
32.8.1 MDI connectors
1171 32.8.2 Crossover function
32.9 System considerations
32.10 Environmental specifications
32.10.1 General safety
32.10.2 Network safety
1172 32.10.2.1 Installation
32.10.2.2 Grounding
32.10.2.3 Installation and maintenance guidelines
32.10.2.4 Telephony voltages
1173 32.10.3 Environment
32.10.3.1 Electromagnetic emission
32.10.3.2 Temperature and humidity
32.10.4 Cabling specifications
32.11 PHY labeling
32.12 Delay constraints
32.12.1 PHY delay constraints (exposed MII)
1174 32.12.2 DTE delay constraints (unexposed MII)
1175 32.13 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 32, Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer and baseband medium, type 100BASE-T2
32.13.1 Identification
32.13.1.1 Implementation identification
32.13.1.2 Protocol summary
1176 32.13.2 Major capabilities/options
32.13.3 Compatibility considerations
1177 32.13.4 PHY control function
1178 32.13.5 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) or Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
32.13.5.1 PCS transmit functions
32.13.5.2 PCS receive functions
1179 32.13.5.3 Other PCS functions
1180 32.13.5.4 PMA functions
1181 32.13.5.5 PMA service interface
1182 32.13.5.6 Management functions
1183 32.13.5.7 100BASE-T2 specific Auto-Negotiation requirements
1184 32.13.5.8 PMA electrical specifications
1191 32.13.5.9 Characteristics of the link segment
1193 32.13.5.10 MDI requirements
32.13.5.11 General safety and environmental requirements
1194 32.13.5.12 Timing requirements exposed MII
32.13.5.13 Timing requirements unexposed MII
32.13.5.14 Timing requirements: carrier assertion/deassertion constraint
1196 33. Data Terminal Equipment (DTE) Power via Media Dependent Interface (MDI)
33.1 Overview
33.1.1 Objectives
33.1.2 Compatibility considerations
1197 33.1.3 Relationship of Power via MDI to the IEEE 802.3 Architecture
1198 33.2 Power sourcing equipment
33.2.1 PSE location
1200 33.2.2 PI pin assignments
1201 33.2.3 PSE state diagrams
33.2.3.1 Overview
33.2.3.2 Conventions
33.2.3.3 Constants
33.2.3.4 Variables
1203 33.2.3.5 Timers
1204 33.2.3.6 Functions
1205 33.2.3.7 State diagrams
1206 33.2.4 PD detection
1207 33.2.5 PSE validation circuit
1208 33.2.5.1 Detection probe requirements
33.2.6 PSE detection of PDs
33.2.6.1 Detection criteria
1209 33.2.6.2 Rejection criteria
33.2.6.3 Open circuit criteria
33.2.7 PSE classification of PDs
33.2.7.1 Classification power levels
33.2.7.2 PSE classification
1211 33.2.8 Power supply output
1212 33.2.8.1 Output voltage
33.2.8.2 Load regulation
33.2.8.3 Power feeding ripple and noise
33.2.8.4 Maximum output current in normal powering mode at PSE min output voltage
33.2.8.5 Output current in startup mode
1213 33.2.8.6 Overload current detection range
33.2.8.7 Overload time limit
33.2.8.8 Output current—at short circuit condition
33.2.8.9 Short circuit time limit
33.2.8.10 Turn off time
1214 33.2.8.11 Turn off voltage
33.2.8.12 Current unbalance
33.2.8.13 Power turn on time
33.2.8.14 PSE stability
33.2.9 Power supply allocation
33.2.10 PSE power removal
33.2.10.1 PSE Maintain Power Signature (MPS) requirements
1215 33.2.10.1.1 PSE AC MPS component requirements
33.2.10.1.2 PSE DC MPS component requirements
1217 33.3 Powered devices
33.3.1 PD PI
33.3.2 PD state diagram
1218 33.3.2.1 Conventions
33.3.2.2 Variables
1219 33.3.2.3 State diagram
33.3.3 PD valid and non-valid detection signatures
1221 33.3.4 PD classifications
33.3.5 PD power
1222 33.3.5.1 Input voltage
33.3.5.2 Input average power
1223 33.3.5.3 Input inrush current
33.3.5.4 Peak operating current
33.3.5.5 PI capacitance during normal powering mode
33.3.5.6 Ripple and noise
33.3.5.7 PD power supply turn on / turn off voltages
33.3.5.8 PD classification stability time
1224 33.3.5.9 PD stability
33.3.5.10 Backfeed voltage
33.3.6 PD Maintain Power Signature
33.3.6.1 Input current
1225 33.4 Additional electrical specifications
33.4.1 Isolation
33.4.1.1 Electrical isolation environments
33.4.1.1.1 Environment A requirements
1226 33.4.1.1.2 Environment B requirements
33.4.2 Fault tolerance
1227 33.4.3 Impedance balance
33.4.4 Common-mode output voltage
1229 33.4.5 Pair-to-pair output noise voltage
1230 33.4.6 Differential noise voltage
33.4.7 Return loss
1231 33.4.8 Midspan PSE device additional requirements
1233 33.4.8.1 “Connector” or “telecom outlet” Midspan PSE device transmission requirements
33.4.8.1.1 NEXT (Near End Crosstalk)
33.4.8.1.2 Insertion loss
33.4.8.1.3 Return loss
33.4.8.1.4 Work area or equipment cable Midspan PSE
1234 33.5 Environmental
33.5.1 General safety
33.5.2 Network safety
33.5.3 Installation and maintenance guidelines
33.5.4 Patch panel considerations
33.5.5 Cabling resistance unbalance
1235 33.5.6 Telephony voltages
33.5.7 Electromagnetic emissions
33.5.8 Temperature and humidity
33.5.9 Labeling
33.6 Management function requirements
33.6.1 PSE registers
1236 33.6.1.1 PSE Control register (Register 11) (R/W)
33.6.1.1.1 Reserved bits (11.15:4)
33.6.1.1.2 Pair Control (11.3:2)
1237 33.6.1.1.3 PSE enable (11.1:0)
33.6.1.2 PSE Status register (Register 12) (R/W)
33.6.1.2.1 Reserved bits (12.15:13)
33.6.1.2.2 Power Denied (12.12)
33.6.1.2.3 Valid Signature (12.11)
33.6.1.2.4 Invalid Signature (12.10)
33.6.1.2.5 Short Circuit (12.9)
33.6.1.2.6 Overload (12.8)
1238 33.6.1.2.7 MPS Absent (12.7)
1239 33.6.1.2.8 PD Class (12.6:4)
33.6.1.2.9 PSE Status (12.3:1)
33.6.1.2.10 Pair Control Ability (12.0)
1240 33.7 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 33, DTE Power via MDI
33.7.1 Introduction
33.7.2 Identification
33.7.2.1 Implementation identification
33.7.2.2 Protocol summary
1241 33.7.2.3 PD Major capabilities/options
33.7.2.4 PSE Major capabilities/options
1242 33.7.3 PICS proforma tables for DTE Power via MDI
33.7.3.1 Common device features
33.7.3.2 Power sourcing equipment
1246 33.7.3.3 Powered devices
1248 33.7.3.4 Electrical specifications applicable to the PSE and PD
1249 33.7.3.5 Electrical specifications applicable to the PSE
1250 33.7.3.6 Electrical specifications applicable to the PD
1251 33.7.3.7 Environmental specifications applicable to PSEs and PDs
33.7.3.8 Environmental specifications applicable to the PSE
33.7.3.9 Management function requirements
1254 Annex 22A (informative) MII output delay, setup, and hold time budget
22A.1 System model
1255 22A.2 Signal transmission path characteristics
1256 22A.3 Budget calculation
1257 Annex 22B (informative) MII driver ac characteristics
22B.1 Implications of CMOS ASIC processes
1258 22B.2 Ro(min) and V, I values for operation from 5 V ± 10% supply
22B.3 Ro(min) and V, I values for operation from 3.3 V ± 0.3 V supply
1259 Annex 22C (informative) Measurement techniques for MII signal timing characteristics
22C.1 Measuring timing characteristics of source terminated signals
22C.2 Measuring timing characteristics of transmit signals at the MII
22C.3 Measuring timing characteristics of receive signals at the MII
1260 22C.4 Measuring timing characteristics of MDIO
1262 Annex 22D (informative) Clause 22 access to Clause 45 MMD registers
22D.1 Write operation
22D.2 Read operation
22D.3 MMD address operations
22D.3.1 Address
1263 22D.3.2 Data, no post increment
22D.3.3 Data, post increment on reads and writes
22D.3.4 Data, post increment on writes only
22D.4 PHY Coexistence and bus conflict avoidance
1264 Annex 23A (normative) 6T codewords
1266 Annex 23B (informative) Noise budget
1267 Annex 23C (informative) Use of cabling systems with a nominal differential characteristic impedance of 120 W
1268 Annex 27A (normative) Repeater delay consistency requirements
1270 Annex 28A (normative) Selector Field definitions
1271 Annex 28B (normative) Selector Field definitions
28B.1 Selector field value
28B.2 Technology Ability Field bit assignments
1272 28B.3 Priority resolution
1273 28B.4 Message Page transmission convention
1274 Annex 28C (normative) Selector Field definitions
1275 28C.1 Message code 0—Auto-Negotiation reserved code 1
28C.2 Message code 1—Null Message code
28C.3 Message code 2—Technology Ability extension code 1
28C.4 Message code 3—Technology Ability extension code 2
28C.5 Message code 4—Remote fault number code
1276 28C.6 Message code 5—Organizationally Unique Identifier (OUI) tag code
28C.7 Message code 6—PHY identifier tag code
1277 28C.8 Message code 2047—Auto-Negotiation reserved code 2
28C.9 Message code 7—100BASE-T2 technology message code
28C.10 Message code 8—1000BASE-T technology message code
28C.11 Message code 9—10GBASE-T and 1000BASE-T technology message code
1278 Annex 28D (normative) Selector Field definitions
28D.1 Introduction
28D.2 Extensions to Clause 28
28D.2.1 Extensions required for Clause 31 (full duplex)
28D.2.2 Extensions required for Clause 32 (100BASE-T2)
28D.3 Extensions for Clause 31
1279 28D.4 Extensions for Clause 32 (100BASE-T2)
28D.5 Extensions required for Clause 40 (1000BASE-T)
1280 28D.6 Extensions required for Clause 55 (10GBASE-T)
1282 Annex 29A (informative) Selector Field definitions
29A.1 DTE delay
29A.2 Repeater delay
1283 Annex 29B (informative) Recommended topology documentation
1284 Annex 30A (normative) Recommended topology documentation
30A.1 DTE MAC entity managed object class
30A.1.1 DTE MAC entity formal definition
1287 30A.1.2 DTE MAC entity attributes
1296 30A.1.3 DTE MAC entity actions
1297 30A.2 DTE physical entity managed object class
30A.2.1 DTE physical entity formal definition
1298 30A.2.2 DTE physical entity attributes
1299 30A.2.3 DTE physical entity actions
1300 30A.3 DTE MAC control entity managed object class
30A.3.1 DTE MAC control entity formal definition
1301 30A.3.2 DTE MAC Control entity attributes
1302 30A.4 DTE MAC Control function entity managed object class
30A.4.1 DTE MAC Control function entity formal definition
1309 30A.4.2 DTE MAC Control function entity attributes
30A.5 Repeater managed object class
30A.5.1 Repeater, formal definition
1310 30A.5.2 Repeater attributes
1313 30A.5.3 Repeater actions
1314 30A.5.4 Repeater notifications
30A.6 Group managed object class
30A.6.1 Group, formal definition
1315 30A.6.2 Group attributes
1316 30A.6.3 Group notifications
30A.7 Repeater port managed object class
30A.7.1 Port, formal definition
1317 30A.7.2 Port attributes
1322 30A.7.3 Port actions
1323 30A.8 MAU managed object class
30A.8.1 MAU, formal definition
1324 30A.8.2 MAU attributes
1329 30A.8.3 MAU actions
30A.8.4 MAU notifications
1330 30A.9 AutoNegotiation managed object class
30A.9.1 AutoNegotiation, formal definition
30A.9.2 Auto-Negotiation attributes
1333 30A.9.3 AutoNegotiation actions
30A.10 ResourceTypeID managed object class
30A.10.1 ResourceTypeID, formal definition
1334 30A.11 Aggregator managed object class
30A.11.1 Aggregator, formal definition
1336 30A.11.2 Aggregator attributes
1344 30A.11.3 Aggregator notifications
30A.12 Aggregation Port managed object class
30A.12.1 Aggregation Port, formal definition
1345 30A.12.2 Aggregation Port attributes
1351 30A.13 Aggregation Port Statistics managed object class
30A.13.1 Aggregation Port Statistics, formal definition
30A.13.2 Aggregation Port Statistics attributes
1354 30A.14 Aggregation Port Debug Information managed object class
30A.14.1 Aggregation Port Debug Information, formal definition
30A.14.2 Aggregation Port Debug Information attributes
1358 30A.15 WIS managed object class
30A.15.1 WIS, formal definition
1359 30A.15.2 WIS attributes
1366 30A.16 PSE managed object class
30A.16.1 PSE, formal definition
1367 30A.16.2 PSE attributes
1369 30A.16.3 PSE actions
30A.17 Midspan managed object class
1370 30A.17.1 Midspan attributes
1371 30A.17.2 Midspan notifications
30A.18 PSE Group managed object class
1372 30A.18.1 PSE Group attributes
30A.18.2 PSE Group notifications
1373 30A.19 OMP entity formal definition
30A.19.1 OMP attributes
1375 30A.20 OAM entity managed object class
30A.20.1 OAM entity formal definition
1376 30A.20.2 OAM entity attributes
1387 30A.20.3 OAM actions
30A.21 PAF managed object class
30A.21.1 PAF formal definition
1390 30A.22 PME managed object class
30A.22.1 PME formal definition
1394 Annex 30B (normative) GDMO and ASN.1 definitions for management
30B.1 Common attributes template
30B.2 ASN.1 module for CSMA/CD managed objects
1408 Annex 31A (normative) MAC Control opcode assignments
1412 Annex 31B (normative) MAC Control PAUSE operation
31B.1 PAUSE description
31B.2 Parameter semantics
1413 31B.3 Detailed specification of PAUSE operation
31B.3.1 Transmit operation
31B.3.2 Transmit state diagram for PAUSE operation
31B.3.2.1 Constants
31B.3.2.2 Variables
1414 31B.3.2.3 Functions
31B.3.2.4 Timers
31B.3.2.5 Messages
31B.3.2.6 Transmit state diagram for PAUSE operation
31B.3.3 Receive operation
1416 31B.3.4 Receive state diagram for PAUSE operation
31B.3.4.1 Constants
31B.3.4.2 Variables
31B.3.4.3 Timers
1417 31B.3.4.4 Receive state diagram (INITIATE MAC CONTROL FUNCTION) for PAUSE operation
31B.3.5 Status indication operation
31B.3.6 Indication state diagram for pause operation
31B.3.6.1 Constants
31B.3.6.2 Variables
1418 31B.3.6.3 Messages
31B.3.6.4 Indication state diagram for PAUSE operation
31B.3.7 Timing considerations for PAUSE operation
1420 31B.4 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for MAC Control PAUSE operation
31B.4.1 Introduction
31B.4.2 Identification
31B.4.2.1 Implementation identification
31B.4.2.2 Protocol summary
1421 31B.4.3 Major capabilities/options
31B.4.4 PAUSE command requirements
31B.4.5 PAUSE command state diagram requirements
1422 31B.4.6 PAUSE command MAC timing considerations
1424 Annex 32A (informative) Use of cabling systems with nominal differential characteristic impedance of 120 ohms or 150 ohms
1426 Annex 33A (informative) PSE detection of PDs
1429 Annex 33B (informative) Cabling guidelines
1430 Annex 33C (informative) Recommended test configurations and procedures
1431 33C.1 Recommended PSE output test procedures
33C.1.1 Test Procedure PSE-1 (output polarity, output voltage, and continuous output power)
1432 33C.1.2 Test Procedure PSE-2 (load regulation)
1433 33C.1.3 Test Procedure PSE-3 (ripple and noise)
33C.1.4 Test Procedure PSE-4 (output current in startup mode)
1435 33C.1.5 Test Procedure PSE-5 (IDLE state current)
1436 33C.1.6 Test Procedure PSE-6 (overload current detection range and overload timings)
1437 33C.1.7 Test Procedure PSE-7 (short circuit current and timing)
1438 33C.1.8 Test Procedure PSE-8 (turn on rise time)
1439 33C.1.9 Test Procedure PSE-9 (turn off time)
1440 33C.1.10 Test Procedure PSE-10 (turn on, detection, and classification time)
1442 33C.1.11 Test Procedure PSE-11 (detection backoff time)
1444 33C.1.12 Test Procedure PSE-12 (port capacitance during detection)
33C.2 Recommended PSE AC disconnect-detection test procedures
33C.2.1 Test Procedure PSE-13 (ac disconnect pulse parameters)
1446 33C.2.2 Test Procedure PSE-14 (port impedance)
1447 33C.3 Recommended PSE detection signature test procedures
33C.3.1 Test Procedure PSE-15 (signature detection parameters)
1450 33C.4 Recommended PD detection signature test procedures
33C.4.1 Test Procedure SIG-1 (PD signature characteristics)
1453 33C.5 Recommended PD power supply test procedures
33C.5.1 Test Procedure PD-1 (all parameters)
1457 Annex 33D (informative) PSE-PD stability
33D.1 Recommended PSE design guidelines and test setup
1459 33D.2 Recommended PD design guidelines
1460 Annex 33E (informative) Cabling resistance unbalance
1462 802.3-2008_section3
SECTION THREE
34. Introduction to 1000 Mb/s baseband network
34.1 Overview
34.1.1 Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and Gigabit Media Independent Interface (GMII)
1463 34.1.2 Physical Layer signaling systems
34.1.3 Repeater
34.1.4 Auto-Negotiation, type 1000BASE-X
1464 34.1.5 Auto-Negotiation, type 1000BASE-T
34.1.6 Management
34.2 State diagrams
34.3 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma
34.4 Relation of Gigabit Ethernet to other standards
1466 35. Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and Gigabit Media Independent Interface (GMII)
35.1 Overview
1467 35.1.1 Summary of major concepts
35.1.2 Application
35.1.3 Rate of operation
35.1.4 Allocation of functions
35.2 Functional specifications
1468 35.2.1 Mapping of GMII signals to PLS service primitives and Station Management
35.2.1.1 Mapping of PLS_DATA.request
35.2.1.1.1 Function
35.2.1.1.2 Semantics of the service primitive
1469 35.2.1.1.3 When generated
35.2.1.2 Mapping of PLS_DATA.indication
35.2.1.2.1 Function
35.2.1.2.2 Semantics of the service primitive
35.2.1.2.3 When generated
35.2.1.3 Mapping of PLS_CARRIER.indication
35.2.1.3.1 Function
35.2.1.3.2 Semantics of the service primitive
35.2.1.3.3 When generated
1470 35.2.1.4 Mapping of PLS_SIGNAL.indication
35.2.1.4.1 Function
35.2.1.4.2 Semantics of the service primitive
35.2.1.4.3 When generated
35.2.1.5 Response to error indications from GMII
35.2.1.6 Conditions for generation of TX_ER
1471 35.2.1.7 Mapping of PLS_DATA_VALID.indication
35.2.1.7.1 Function
35.2.1.7.2 Semantics of the service primitive
35.2.1.7.3 When generated
35.2.2 GMII signal functional specifications
35.2.2.1 GTX_CLK (1000 Mb/s transmit clock)
35.2.2.2 RX_CLK (receive clock)
1472 35.2.2.3 TX_EN (transmit enable)
35.2.2.4 TXD (transmit data)
1473 35.2.2.5 TX_ER (transmit coding error)
1475 35.2.2.6 RX_DV (receive data valid)
35.2.2.7 RXD (receive data)
1477 35.2.2.8 RX_ER (receive error)
1478 35.2.2.9 CRS (carrier sense)
1479 35.2.2.10 COL (collision detected)
35.2.2.11 MDC (management data clock)
35.2.2.12 MDIO (management data input/output)
35.2.3 GMII data stream
35.2.3.1 Inter-frame
1480 35.2.3.2 Preamble and start of frame delimiter
35.2.3.2.1 Transmit case
35.2.3.2.2 Receive case
1481 35.2.3.3 Data
35.2.3.4 End-of-Frame delimiter
1482 35.2.3.5 Carrier extension
35.2.3.6 Definition of Start of Packet and End of Packet Delimiters
35.2.4 MAC delay constraints (with GMII)
35.2.5 Management functions
35.3 Signal mapping
1483 35.4 Electrical characteristics
35.4.1 DC characteristics
35.4.2 AC characteristics
1484 35.4.2.1 Signal Timing measurements
1485 35.4.2.2 GMII test circuit topology
1486 35.4.2.3 GMII ac specifications
1488 35.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 35, Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and Gigabit Media Independent Interface (GMII)
35.5.1 Introduction
35.5.2 Identification
35.5.2.1 Implementation identification
35.5.2.2 Protocol summary
1489 35.5.2.3 Major capabilities/options
35.5.3 PICS proforma tables for reconciliation sublayer and Gigabit Media Independent Interface
35.5.3.1 Mapping of PLS service primitives
35.5.3.2 GMII signal functional specifications
1491 35.5.3.3 Data stream structure
35.5.3.4 Delay constraints
35.5.3.5 Management functions
1492 35.5.3.6 Electrical characteristics
1494 36. Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) and Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer, type 1000BASE-X
36.1 Overview
36.1.1 Scope
36.1.2 Objectives
36.1.3 Relationship of 1000BASE-X to other standards
1495 36.1.4 Summary of 1000BASE-X sublayers
36.1.4.1 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
36.1.4.2 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
36.1.4.3 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer
36.1.5 Inter-sublayer interfaces
1496 36.1.6 Functional block diagram
36.1.7 State diagram conventions
1497 36.2 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
36.2.1 PCS Interface (GMII)
1498 36.2.2 Functions within the PCS
36.2.3 Use of code-groups
36.2.4 8B/10B transmission code
1499 36.2.4.1 Notation conventions
36.2.4.2 Transmission order
1500 36.2.4.3 Valid and invalid code-groups
36.2.4.4 Running disparity rules
1501 36.2.4.5 Generating code-groups
36.2.4.6 Checking the validity of received code-groups
36.2.4.7 Ordered_sets
36.2.4.7.1 Ordered_set rules
1506 36.2.4.8 /K28.5/ code-group considerations
1507 36.2.4.9 Comma considerations
36.2.4.10 Configuration (/C/)
1508 36.2.4.11 Data (/D/)
36.2.4.12 IDLE (/I/)
36.2.4.13 Start_of_Packet (SPD) delimiter
36.2.4.14 End_of_Packet delimiter (EPD)
1509 36.2.4.14.1 EPD rules
36.2.4.15 Carrier_Extend (/R/)
36.2.4.15.1 Carrier_Extend rules
36.2.4.16 Error_Propagation (/V/)
1510 36.2.4.17 Encapsulation
36.2.4.18 Mapping between GMII, PCS and PMA
1511 36.2.5 Detailed functions and state diagrams
36.2.5.1 State variables
36.2.5.1.1 Notation conventions
36.2.5.1.2 Constants
1512 36.2.5.1.3 Variables
1515 36.2.5.1.4 Functions
1516 36.2.5.1.5 Counters
36.2.5.1.6 Message
1517 36.2.5.1.7 Timer
36.2.5.2 State diagrams
36.2.5.2.1 Transmit
1522 36.2.5.2.2 Receive
36.2.5.2.3 State variable function carrier_detect(x)
36.2.5.2.4 Code-group stream decoding
1523 36.2.5.2.5 Carrier sense
36.2.5.2.6 Synchronization
36.2.5.2.7 Auto-Negotiation process
1525 36.3 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
36.3.1 Service Interface
36.3.1.1 PMA_UNITDATA.request
36.3.1.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
36.3.1.1.2 When generated
36.3.1.1.3 Effect of receipt
36.3.1.2 PMA_UNITDATA.indication
36.3.1.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
1526 36.3.1.2.2 When generated
36.3.1.2.3 Effect of receipt
36.3.2 Functions within the PMA
36.3.2.1 Data delay
36.3.2.2 PMA transmit function
36.3.2.3 PMA receive function
1527 36.3.2.4 Code-group alignment
36.3.3 A physical instantiation of the PMA Service Interface
36.3.3.1 Required signals
1530 36.3.3.2 Summary of control signal usage
36.3.4 General electrical characteristics of the TBI
36.3.4.1 DC characteristics
36.3.4.2 Valid signal levels
36.3.4.3 Rise and fall time definition
1531 36.3.4.4 Output load
1532 36.3.5 TBI transmit interface electrical characteristics
36.3.5.1 Transmit data (tx_code-group)
36.3.5.2 TBI transmit interface timing
36.3.6 TBI receive interface electrical characteristics
1533 36.3.6.1 Receive data (rx_code-group)
36.3.6.2 Receive clock (PMA_RX_CLK, PMA_RX_CLK)
36.3.7 Loopback mode
1534 36.3.7.1 Receiver considerations
36.3.7.2 Transmitter considerations
36.3.8 Test functions
36.4 Compatibility considerations
36.5 Delay constraints
1535 36.5.1 MDI to GMII delay constraints
36.5.2 DTE delay constraints (half duplex mode)
1536 36.5.3 Carrier de-assertion/assertion constraint (half duplex mode)
36.6 Environmental specifications
36.7 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 36, Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) and Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer, type 1000BASE-X
36.7.1 Introduction
1537 36.7.2 Identification
36.7.2.1 Implementation identification
36.7.2.2 Protocol summary
1538 36.7.3 Major Capabilities/Options
36.7.4 PICS proforma tables for the PCS and PMA sublayer, type 1000BASE-X
36.7.4.1 Compatibility considerations
36.7.4.2 Code-group functions
1539 36.7.4.3 State diagrams
36.7.4.4 PMA functions
1540 36.7.4.5 PMA transmit function
36.7.4.6 PMA code-group alignment function
36.7.4.7 TBI
36.7.4.8 Delay constraints
1542 37. Auto-Negotiation function, type 1000BASE-X
37.1 Overview
37.1.1 Scope
37.1.2 Application perspective/objectives
1543 37.1.3 Relationship to ISO/IEC 8802-3
37.1.4 Compatibility considerations
37.1.4.1 Auto-Negotiation
37.1.4.2 Management interface
1544 37.1.4.2.1 GMII management interface
37.1.4.3 Interoperability between Auto-Negotiation compatible devices
37.1.4.4 User Configuration with Auto-Negotiation
37.2 Functional specifications
37.2.1 Config_Reg encoding
37.2.1.1 Base page to management register mapping
1545 37.2.1.2 Full duplex
37.2.1.3 Half duplex
37.2.1.4 Pause
37.2.1.5 Remote fault
1546 37.2.1.5.1 No error, link OK
37.2.1.5.2 Offline
37.2.1.5.3 Link_Failure
1547 37.2.1.5.4 Auto-Negotiation_Error
37.2.1.6 Acknowledge
37.2.1.7 Next page
37.2.2 Transmit function requirements
37.2.2.1 Transmit function to Auto-Negotiation process interface requirements
37.2.3 Receive function requirements
1548 37.2.3.1 Receive function to Auto-Negotiation process interface requirements
37.2.4 Arbitration process requirements
37.2.4.1 Renegotiation function
37.2.4.2 Priority resolution function
37.2.4.3 Next Page function
1550 37.2.4.3.1 Next page encodings
37.2.4.3.2 Next page
37.2.4.3.3 Acknowledge
37.2.4.3.4 Message page
1551 37.2.4.3.5 Acknowledge 2
37.2.4.3.6 Toggle
37.2.4.3.7 Message page encoding
37.2.4.3.8 Message Code Field
37.2.4.3.9 Unformatted page encoding
37.2.4.3.10 Unformatted Code Field
37.2.4.3.11 Use of next pages
1552 37.2.4.3.12 Management register requirements
37.2.5 Management function requirements
37.2.5.1 Management registers
37.2.5.1.1 Control register (Register 0)
37.2.5.1.2 Status register (Register 1)
37.2.5.1.3 AN advertisement register (Register 4) (R/W)
1553 37.2.5.1.4 AN link partner ability base page register (Register 5) (RO)
37.2.5.1.5 AN expansion register (Register 6) (RO)
1554 37.2.5.1.6 AN next page transmit register (Register 7)
37.2.5.1.7 AN link partner ability next page register (Register 8)
37.2.5.1.8 Extended status register (Register 15)
37.2.5.1.9 State diagram variable to management register mapping
37.2.5.2 Auto-Negotiation managed object class
1555 37.2.6 Absence of management function
37.3 Detailed functions and state diagrams
37.3.1 State diagram variables
1556 37.3.1.1 Variables
1558 37.3.1.2 Functions
1560 37.3.1.3 Messages
37.3.1.4 Timers
37.3.1.5 State diagrams
37.4 Environmental specifications
1562 37.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 37, Auto-Negotiation function, type 1000BASE-X
37.5.1 Introduction
37.5.2 Identification
37.5.2.1 Implementation identification
37.5.2.2 Protocol summary
1563 37.5.3 Major Capabilities/Options
37.5.4 PICS proforma tables for the Auto-Negotiation function, type 1000BASE-X
37.5.4.1 Compatibility considerations
37.5.4.2 Auto-Negotiation functions
37.5.4.2.1 Config_Reg
1564 37.5.4.2.2 Remote Fault functions
37.5.4.2.3 AN transmit functions
37.5.4.2.4 AN receive functions
37.5.4.2.5 Priority resolution functions
1565 37.5.4.2.6 Next page functions
37.5.4.2.7 Management registers
1566 38. Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 1000BASE-LX (long wavelength laser) and 1000BASE-SX (short wavelength laser)
38.1 Overview
38.1.1 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer service interface
38.1.1.1 PMD_UNITDATA.request
38.1.1.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
38.1.1.1.2 When generated
38.1.1.1.3 Effect of receipt
1567 38.1.1.2 PMD_UNITDATA.indication
38.1.1.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
38.1.1.2.2 When generated
38.1.1.2.3 Effect of receipt
38.1.1.3 PMD_SIGNAL.indication
38.1.1.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
38.1.1.3.2 When generated
38.1.1.3.3 Effect of receipt
38.1.2 Medium Dependent Interface (MDI)
1568 38.2 PMD functional specifications
38.2.1 PMD block diagram
38.2.2 PMD transmit function
38.2.3 PMD receive function
1569 38.2.4 PMD signal detect function
38.3 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-SX
1570 38.3.1 Transmitter optical specifications
1571 38.3.2 Receive optical specifications
38.3.3 Worst-case 1000BASE-SX link power budget and penalties (informative)
1572 38.4 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-LX
38.4.1 Transmitter optical specifications
1573 38.4.2 Receive optical specifications
1574 38.4.3 Worst-case 1000BASE-LX link power budget and penalties (informative)
38.5 Jitter specifications for 1000BASE-SX and 1000BASE-LX
1575 38.6 Optical measurement requirements
38.6.1 Center wavelength and spectral width measurements
38.6.2 Optical power measurements
38.6.3 Extinction ratio measurements
38.6.4 Relative Intensity Noise (RIN)
38.6.5 Transmitter optical waveform (transmit eye)
1576 38.6.6 Transmit rise/fall characteristics
38.6.7 Receive sensitivity measurements
1577 38.6.8 Total jitter measurements
38.6.9 Deterministic jitter measurement (informative)
38.6.10 Coupled Power Ratio (CPR) measurements
1578 38.6.11 Conformance test signal at TP3 for receiver testing
1579 38.6.12 Measurement of the receiver 3 dB electrical upper cutoff frequency
1580 38.7 Environmental specifications
38.7.1 General safety
38.7.2 Laser safety
38.7.3 Installation
38.8 Environment
1581 38.8.1 Electromagnetic emission
38.8.2 Temperature, humidity, and handling
38.9 PMD labeling requirements
38.10 Fiber optic cabling model
1582 38.11 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling
38.11.1 Optical fiber and cable
1583 38.11.2 Optical fiber connection
38.11.2.1 Connection insertion loss
38.11.2.2 Connection return loss
38.11.3 Medium Dependent Interface (MDI)
1584 38.11.4 Single-mode fiber offset-launch mode-conditioning patch cord for MMF operation of 1000BASE-LX
1586 38.12 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 38, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 1000BASE-LX (Long Wavelength Laser) and 1000BASE-SX (Short Wavelength Laser)
38.12.1 Introduction
38.12.2 Identification
38.12.2.1 Implementation identification
38.12.2.2 Protocol summary
1587 38.12.3 Major capabilities/options
1588 38.12.4 PICS proforma tables for Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 1000BASE-LX (Long Wavelength Laser) and 1000BASE-SX (Short Wavelength Laser)
38.12.4.1 PMD functional specifications
38.12.4.2 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-SX
1589 38.12.4.3 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-LX
38.12.4.4 Jitter specifications
38.12.4.5 Optical measurement requirements
1592 38.12.4.6 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling
1594 39. Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 1000BASE-CX (short-haul copper)
39.1 Overview
39.2 Functional specifications
39.2.1 PMD transmit function
39.2.2 PMD receive function
39.2.3 PMD signal detect function
1595 39.3 PMD to MDI electrical specifications
1596 39.3.1 Transmitter electrical specifications
1598 39.3.2 Receiver electrical specifications
1599 39.3.3 Jitter specifications for 1000BASE-CX
1600 39.4 Jumper cable assembly characteristics
39.4.1 Compensation networks
39.4.2 Shielding
39.5 MDI specification
1601 39.5.1 MDI connectors
39.5.1.1 Style-1 connector specification
1602 39.5.1.2 Style-2 connector specification
1603 39.5.1.3 Style-2 connector example drawing (informative)
39.5.2 Crossover function
1604 39.6 Electrical measurement requirements
39.6.1 Transmit rise/fall time
39.6.2 Transmit skew measurement
39.6.3 Transmit eye (normalized and absolute)
39.6.4 Through_connection impedance
39.6.5 Jumper cable intra-pair differential skew
1605 39.6.6 Receiver link signal
39.6.7 Near-End Cross Talk (NEXT)
39.6.8 Differential time-domain reflectometry (TDR) measurement procedure
39.6.8.1 Driving waveform
1606 39.6.8.2 Calibration of the test setup
39.7 Environmental specifications
1607 39.8 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 39, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 1000BASE-CX
39.8.1 Introduction
39.8.2 Identification
39.8.2.1 Implementation identification
39.8.2.2 Protocol summary
1608 39.8.3 Major capabilities/options
39.8.4 PICS proforma tables for Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 1000BASE-CX (short-haul copper)
39.8.4.1 PMD functional specifications
1609 39.8.4.2 PMD to MDI electrical specifications
1610 39.8.4.3 Jumper cable assembly characteristics
1611 39.8.4.4 Other requirements
1612 40. Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer and baseband medium, type 1000BASE-T
40.1 Overview
40.1.1 Objectives
40.1.2 Relationship of 1000BASE-T to other standards
40.1.3 Operation of 1000BASE-T
1616 40.1.3.1 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
40.1.3.2 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
1617 40.1.4 Signaling
40.1.5 Inter-sublayer interfaces
40.1.6 Conventions in this clause
1618 40.2 1000BASE-T Service Primitives and Interfaces
40.2.1 Technology-Dependent Interface
40.2.1.1 PMA_LINK.request
40.2.1.1.1 Semantics of the primitive
40.2.1.1.2 When generated
1619 40.2.1.1.3 Effect of receipt
40.2.1.2 PMA_LINK.indication
40.2.1.2.1 Semantics of the primitive
40.2.1.2.2 When generated
40.2.1.2.3 Effect of receipt
40.2.2 PMA Service Interface
1620 40.2.3 PMA_TXMODE.indication
40.2.3.1 Semantics of the primitive
1621 40.2.3.2 When generated
40.2.3.3 Effect of receipt
40.2.4 PMA_CONFIG.indication
40.2.4.1 Semantics of the primitive
40.2.4.2 When generated
40.2.4.3 Effect of receipt
40.2.5 PMA_UNITDATA.request
40.2.5.1 Semantics of the primitive
1622 40.2.5.2 When generated
40.2.5.3 Effect of receipt
40.2.6 PMA_UNITDATA.indication
40.2.6.1 Semantics of the primitive
40.2.6.2 When generated
40.2.6.3 Effect of receipt
1623 40.2.7 PMA_SCRSTATUS.request
40.2.7.1 Semantics of the primitive
40.2.7.2 When generated
40.2.7.3 Effect of receipt
40.2.8 PMA_RXSTATUS.indication
40.2.8.1 Semantics of the primitive
40.2.8.2 When generated
40.2.8.3 Effect of receipt
1624 40.2.9 PMA_REMRXSTATUS.request
40.2.9.1 Semantics of the primitive
40.2.9.2 When generated
40.2.9.3 Effect of receipt
40.2.10 PMA_RESET.indication
40.2.10.1 When generated
40.2.10.2 Effect of receipt
40.3 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
1625 40.3.1 PCS functions
40.3.1.1 PCS Reset function
1626 40.3.1.2 PCS Data Transmission Enable
40.3.1.3 PCS Transmit function
1627 40.3.1.3.1 Side-stream scrambler polynomials
40.3.1.3.2 Generation of bits Sxn[3:0], Syn[3:0], and Sgn[3:0]
1629 40.3.1.3.3 Generation of bits Scn[7:0]
40.3.1.3.4 Generation of bits Sdn[8:0]
1631 40.3.1.3.5 Generation of quinary symbols TAn, TBn, TCn, TDn
1637 40.3.1.3.6 Generation of An, Bn, Cn, Dn
1638 40.3.1.4 PCS Receive function
1639 40.3.1.4.1 Decoding of code-groups
40.3.1.4.2 Receiver descrambler polynomials
40.3.1.5 PCS Carrier Sense function
1640 40.3.2 Stream structure
40.3.3 State variables
40.3.3.1 Variables
1643 40.3.3.2 Functions
40.3.3.3 Timer
1644 40.3.3.4 Messages
40.3.4 State diagrams
1648 40.3.4.1 Supplement to state diagram
1649 40.4 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
40.4.1 PMA functional specifications
1650 40.4.2 PMA functions
40.4.2.1 PMA Reset function
40.4.2.2 PMA Transmit function
40.4.2.3 PMA Receive function
1651 40.4.2.4 PHY Control function
40.4.2.5 Link Monitor function
1652 40.4.2.6 Clock Recovery function
40.4.3 MDI
40.4.3.1 MDI signals transmitted by the PHY
40.4.3.2 Signals received at the MDI
1653 40.4.4 Automatic MDI/MDI-X Configuration
40.4.4.1 Description of Automatic MDI/MDI-X state diagram
40.4.4.2 Pseudo-random sequence generator
40.4.5 State variables
40.4.5.1 State diagram variables
1655 40.4.5.2 Timers
1656 40.4.6 State Diagrams
40.4.6.1 PHY Control state diagram
1657 40.4.6.2 Link Monitor state diagram
1658 40.4.6.2.1 Auto Crossover state diagram
40.5 Management interface
40.5.1 Support for Auto-Negotiation
1659 40.5.1.1 1000BASE-T use of registers during Auto-Negotiation
1661 40.5.1.2 1000BASE-T Auto-Negotiation page use
1662 40.5.1.3 Sending next pages
40.5.2 MASTER-SLAVE configuration resolution
1664 40.6 PMA electrical specifications
40.6.1 PMA-to-MDI interface tests
40.6.1.1 Isolation requirement
40.6.1.1.1 Test channel
1665 40.6.1.1.2 Test modes
1669 40.6.1.1.3 Test Fixtures
1672 40.6.1.2 Transmitter electrical specifications
40.6.1.2.1 Peak differential output voltage and level accuracy
40.6.1.2.2 Maximum output droop
40.6.1.2.3 Differential output templates
1680 40.6.1.2.4 Transmitter distortion
1682 40.6.1.2.5 Transmitter timing jitter
1683 40.6.1.2.6 Transmit clock frequency
40.6.1.3 Receiver electrical specifications
40.6.1.3.1 Receiver differential input signals
40.6.1.3.2 Receiver frequency tolerance
40.6.1.3.3 Common-mode noise rejection
1685 40.6.1.3.4 Alien Crosstalk noise rejection
1686 40.7 Link segment characteristics
40.7.1 Cabling system characteristics
40.7.2 Link transmission parameters
40.7.2.1 Insertion loss
40.7.2.2 Differential characteristic impedance
40.7.2.3 Return loss
1687 40.7.3 Coupling parameters
40.7.3.1 Near-End Crosstalk (NEXT)
40.7.3.1.1 Differential Near-End Crosstalk
40.7.3.2 Far-End Crosstalk (FEXT)
40.7.3.2.1 Equal Level Far-End Crosstalk (ELFEXT) loss
1688 40.7.3.2.2 Multiple Disturber Equal Level Far-End Crosstalk (MDELFEXT) loss
40.7.3.2.3 Multiple-Disturber Power Sum Equal Level Far-End Crosstalk (PSELFEXT) loss
40.7.4 Delay
40.7.4.1 Maximum link delay
40.7.4.2 Link delay skew
40.7.5 Noise environment
1689 40.7.6 External coupled noise
40.8 MDI specification
40.8.1 MDI connectors
1690 40.8.2 Crossover function
1691 40.8.3 MDI electrical specifications
40.8.3.1 MDI return loss
40.8.3.2 MDI impedance balance
1692 40.8.3.3 MDI common-mode output voltage
40.8.3.4 MDI fault tolerance
1693 40.9 Environmental specifications
40.9.1 General safety
40.9.2 Network safety
40.9.2.1 Installation
40.9.2.2 Installation and maintenance guidelines
1694 40.9.2.3 Telephony voltages
40.9.3 Environment
40.9.3.1 Electromagnetic emission
40.9.3.2 Temperature and humidity
40.10 PHY labeling
1695 40.11 Delay constraints
40.11.1 MDI to GMII delay constraints
40.11.2 DTE delay constraints (half duplex only)
1696 40.11.3 Carrier de-assertion/assertion constraint (half duplex mode)
1697 40.12 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 40—Physical coding sublayer (PCS), physical medium attachment (PMA) sublayer and baseband medium, type 1000BASE-T
40.12.1 Identification
40.12.1.1 Implementation identification
40.12.1.2 Protocol summary
40.12.2 Major capabilities/options
1698 40.12.3 Clause conventions
40.12.4 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
1700 40.12.4.1 PCS receive functions
1701 40.12.4.2 Other PCS functions
1702 40.12.5 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA)
1703 40.12.6 Management interface
1704 40.12.6.1 1000BASE-T Specific Auto-Negotiation Requirements
1705 40.12.7 PMA Electrical Specifications
1711 40.12.8 Characteristics of the link segment
1712 40.12.9 MDI requirements
1714 40.12.10 General safety and environmental requirements
40.12.11 Timing requirements
1716 41. Repeater for 1000 Mb/s baseband networks
41.1 Overview
41.1.1 Scope
41.1.1.1 Repeater set
1717 41.1.1.2 Repeater unit
41.1.2 Application perspective
41.1.2.1 Objectives
41.1.2.2 Compatibility considerations
41.1.2.2.1 Internal segment compatibility
41.1.3 Relationship to PHY
41.2 Repeater functional specifications
1718 41.2.1 Repeater functions
41.2.1.1 Signal restoration functional requirements
41.2.1.1.1 Signal amplification
41.2.1.1.2 Signal wave-shape restoration
1719 41.2.1.1.3 Signal retiming
41.2.1.2 Data-handling functional requirements
41.2.1.2.1 Data frame forwarding
41.2.1.2.2 Received code violations
41.2.1.3 Received event-handling functional requirements
41.2.1.3.1 Received event handling
41.2.1.3.2 Preamble regeneration
41.2.1.3.3 Start-of-packet propagation delay
1720 41.2.1.3.4 Start-of-packet variability
41.2.1.4 Collision-handling functional requirements
41.2.1.4.1 Collision detection
41.2.1.4.2 Jam generation
41.2.1.4.3 Start-of-collision-jam propagation delay
41.2.1.4.4 Cessation-of-collision Jam propagation delay
41.2.1.5 Error-handling functional requirements
41.2.1.5.1 Carrier integrity functional requirements
1721 41.2.1.5.2 Speed handling
41.2.1.6 Partition functional requirements
1722 41.2.1.7 Receive jabber functional requirements
41.2.2 Detailed repeater functions and state diagrams
1723 41.2.2.1 State diagram variables
41.2.2.1.1 Constants
41.2.2.1.2 Variables
1724 41.2.2.1.3 Functions
41.2.2.1.4 Timers
1725 41.2.2.1.5 Counters
41.2.2.1.6 Port designation
1726 41.2.2.2 State diagrams
1730 41.3 Repeater electrical specifications
41.3.1 Electrical isolation
41.4 Environmental specifications
41.4.1 General safety
41.4.2 Network safety
41.4.2.1 Installation
41.4.2.2 Grounding
1731 41.4.2.3 Installation and maintenance guidelines
41.4.3 Electrical isolation
41.4.3.1 Environment A requirements
41.4.3.2 Environment B requirements
41.4.4 Reliability
1732 41.4.5 Environment
41.4.5.1 Electromagnetic emission
41.4.5.2 Temperature and humidity
41.5 Repeater labeling
41.6 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 41, Repeater for 1000 Mb/s baseband networks
41.6.1 Introduction
1733 41.6.2 Identification
41.6.2.1 Implementation identification
41.6.2.2 Protocol summary
41.6.3 Major capabilities/options
1734 41.6.4 PICS proforma tables for the Repeater for 1000 Mb/s baseband networks
41.6.4.1 Compatibility considerations
41.6.4.2 Repeater functions
1735 41.6.4.3 Signal restoration function
41.6.4.4 Data-Handling function
1736 41.6.4.5 Receive Event-Handling function
41.6.4.6 Collision-Handling function
1737 41.6.4.7 Error-Handling function
1738 41.6.4.8 Partition function
41.6.4.9 Receive Jabber function
1739 41.6.4.10 Repeater state diagrams
41.6.4.11 Repeater electrical
1740 41.6.4.12 Repeater labeling
1742 42. System considerations for multisegment 1000 Mb/s networks
42.1 Overview
1743 42.1.1 Single collision domain multisegment networks
1744 42.1.2 Repeater usage
42.2 Transmission System Model 1
42.3 Transmission System Model 2
1745 42.3.1 Round-trip collision delay
1746 42.3.1.1 Worst-case path delay value (PDV) selection
42.3.1.2 Worst-case PDV calculation
1748 42.4 Full duplex 1000 Mb/s topology limitations
1750 43. Content moved to IEEE Std 802.1AX-2008
1752 Annex 36A (informative) Jitter test patterns
36A.1 High-frequency test pattern
36A.2 Low-frequency test pattern
36A.3 Mixed frequency test pattern
36A.4 Long continuous random test pattern
1753 36A.5 Short continuous random test pattern
1755 Annex 36B (informative) 8B/10B transmission code running disparity calculation examples
1758 Annex 38A (informative) Fiber launch conditions
38A.1 Overfilled Launch
38A.2 Radial Overfilled Launch (ROFL)
1760 Annex 40A (informative) Additional cabling design guidelines
40A.1 Alien crosstalk
40A.1.1 Multipair cabling (i.e., greater than 4-pair)
40A.1.2 Bundled or hybrid cable configurations
40A.2 Cabling configurations
1762 Annex 40B (informative) Description of cable clamp
1764 40B.1 Cable clamp validation
1766 Annex 40C (informative) Add-on interface for additional Next Pages
1768 40C.1 State variables
40C.2 State diagrams
40C.2.1 Auto-Negotiation Transmit state diagram add-on for 1000BASE-T
1771 40C.2.2 Auto-Negotiation Receive state diagram add-on for 1000BASE-T
1774 Annex 43A–Annex 43A is no longer in use.
1775 Annex 43B–Annex 43B is no longer in use.
1776 Annex 43C–Annex 43C is no longer in use.
1777 802.3-2008_section4
SECTION FOUR
44. Introduction to 10 Gb/s baseband network
44.1 Overview
44.1.1 Scope
44.1.2 Objectives
1778 44.1.3 Relationship of 10 Gigabit Ethernet to the ISO OSI reference model
1779 44.1.4 Summary of 10 Gigabit Ethernet sublayers
44.1.4.1 Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and 10 Gigabit Media Independent Interface (XGMII)
44.1.4.2 XGMII Extender Sublayer (XGXS) and 10 Gigabit Attachment Unit Interface (XAUI)
44.1.4.3 Management interface (MDIO/MDC)
44.1.4.4 Physical Layer signaling systems
1780 44.1.4.5 WAN Interface Sublayer (WIS), type 10GBASE-W
44.1.5 Management
44.2 State diagrams
44.3 Delay constraints
1782 44.4 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma
44.5 Relation of 10 Gigabit Ethernet to other standards
1785 45. Management Data Input/Output (MDIO) Interface
45.1 Overview
45.1.1 Summary of major concepts
45.1.2 Application
1786 45.2 MDIO Interface Registers
1790 45.2.1 PMA/PMD registers
1792 45.2.1.1 PMA/PMD control 1 register (Register 1.0)
45.2.1.1.1 Reset (1.0.15)
1793 45.2.1.1.2 Low power (1.0.11)
1794 45.2.1.1.3 Speed selection (1.0.13,1.0.6, 1.0.5:2)
45.2.1.1.4 PMA loopback (1.0.0)
45.2.1.2 PMA/PMD status 1 register (Register 1.1)
45.2.1.2.1 Fault (1.1.7)
1795 45.2.1.2.2 Receive link status (1.1.2)
45.2.1.2.3 Low-power ability (1.1.1)
45.2.1.3 PMA/PMD device identifier (Registers 1.2 and 1.3)
45.2.1.4 PMA/PMD speed ability (Register 1.4)
1796 45.2.1.4.1 10M capable (1.4.6)
45.2.1.4.2 100M capable (1.4.5)
45.2.1.4.3 1000M capable (1.4.4)
45.2.1.4.4 10PASS-TS capable (1.4.2)
45.2.1.4.5 2BASE-TL capable (1.4.1)
45.2.1.4.6 10G capable (1.4.0)
1797 45.2.1.5 PMA/PMD devices in package (Registers 1.5 and 1.6)
45.2.1.6 PMA/PMD control 2 register (Register 1.7)
45.2.1.6.1 PMA/PMD type selection (1.7.3:0)
45.2.1.7 10G PMA/PMD status 2 register (Register 1.8)
1799 45.2.1.7.1 Device present (1.8.15:14)
45.2.1.7.2 Transmit fault ability (1.8.13)
45.2.1.7.3 Receive fault ability (1.8.12)
45.2.1.7.4 Transmit fault (1.8.11)
45.2.1.7.5 Receive fault (1.8.10)
45.2.1.7.6 PMA/PMD extended abilities (1.8.9)
1800 45.2.1.7.7 PMD transmit disable ability (1.8.8)
45.2.1.7.8 10GBASE-SR ability (1.8.7)
45.2.1.7.9 10GBASE-LR ability (1.8.6)
45.2.1.7.10 10GBASE-ER ability (1.8.5)
45.2.1.7.11 10GBASE-LX4 ability (1.8.4)
45.2.1.7.12 10GBASE-SW ability (1.8.3)
45.2.1.7.13 10GBASE-LW ability (1.8.2)
45.2.1.7.14 10GBASE-EW ability (1.8.1)
45.2.1.7.15 PMA loopback ability (1.8.0)
1801 45.2.1.8 10G PMD transmit disable register (Register 1.9)
45.2.1.8.1 PMD transmit disable 3 (1.9.4)
45.2.1.8.2 PMD transmit disable 2 (1.9.3)
1802 45.2.1.8.3 PMD transmit disable 1 (1.9.2)
45.2.1.8.4 PMD transmit disable 0 (1.9.1)
45.2.1.8.5 Global PMD transmit disable (1.9.0)
45.2.1.9 10G PMD receive signal detect register (Register 1.10)
45.2.1.9.1 PMD receive signal detect 3 (1.10.4)
45.2.1.9.2 PMD receive signal detect 2 (1.10.3)
1803 45.2.1.9.3 PMD receive signal detect 1 (1.10.2)
45.2.1.9.4 PMD receive signal detect 0 (1.10.1)
45.2.1.9.5 Global PMD receive signal detect (1.10.0)
1804 45.2.1.10 PMA/PMD extended ability register (Register 1.11)
45.2.1.10.1 10BASE-T ability (1.11.8)
45.2.1.10.2 100BASE-TX ability (1.11.7)
45.2.1.10.3 1000BASE-KX ability (1.11.6)
1805 45.2.1.10.4 1000BASE-T ability (1.11.5)
45.2.1.10.5 10GBASE-KR ability (1.11.4)
45.2.1.10.6 10GBASE-KX4 ability (1.11.3)
45.2.1.10.7 10GBASE-T ability (1.11.2)
45.2.1.10.8 10GBASE-LRM ability (1.11.1)
45.2.1.10.9 10GBASE-CX4 ability (1.11.0)
45.2.1.11 PMA/PMD package identifier (Registers 1.14 and 1.15)
45.2.1.12 10P/2B PMA/PMD control register (Register 1.30)
45.2.1.12.1 PMA/PMD link control (1.30.15)
1806 45.2.1.12.2 STFU (1.30.14)
45.2.1.12.3 Silence time (1.30.13:8)
45.2.1.12.4 Port subtype select (1.30.7)
1807 45.2.1.12.5 Handshake cleardown (1.30.6)
45.2.1.12.6 Ignore incoming handshake (1.30.5)
45.2.1.12.7 PMA/PMD type selection (1.30.4:0)
45.2.1.13 10P/2B PMA/PMD status register (Register 1.31)
45.2.1.13.1 Data rate (1.31.15:5)
45.2.1.13.2 CO supported (1.31.4)
45.2.1.13.3 CPE supported (1.31.3)
1808 45.2.1.13.4 PMA/PMD link status (1.31.2:0)
45.2.1.14 Link partner PMA/PMD control register (Register 1.32)
1809 45.2.1.14.1 Get link partner parameters (1.32.15)
1810 45.2.1.14.2 Send link partner parameters (1.32.13)
45.2.1.15 Link partner PMA/PMD status register (Register 1.33)
45.2.1.15.1 Get link partner result (1.33.14)
45.2.1.15.2 Send link partner result (1.33.12)
1811 45.2.1.16 10P/2B PMA/PMD link loss register (Register 1.36)
45.2.1.17 10P/2B RX SNR margin register (Register 1.37)
45.2.1.18 10P/2B link partner RX SNR margin register (Register 1.38)
45.2.1.19 10P/2B line attenuation register (Register 1.39)
1812 45.2.1.20 10P/2B link partner line attenuation register (Register 1.40)
45.2.1.21 10P/2B line quality thresholds register (Register 1.41)
45.2.1.21.1 Loop attenuation threshold (1.41.15:8)
45.2.1.21.2 SNR margin threshold (1.41.7:4)
45.2.1.22 2B link partner line quality thresholds register (Register 1.42)
1813 45.2.1.23 10P FEC correctable errors counter (Register 1.43)
45.2.1.24 10P FEC uncorrectable errors counter (Register 1.44)
45.2.1.25 10P link partner FEC correctable errors register (Register 1.45)
1814 45.2.1.26 10P link partner FEC uncorrectable errors register (Register 1.46)
45.2.1.27 10P electrical length register (Register 1.47)
45.2.1.27.1 Electrical length (1.47.15:0)
45.2.1.28 10P link partner electrical length register (Register 1.48)
45.2.1.29 10P PMA/PMD general configuration register (Register 1.49)
45.2.1.29.1 TX window length (1.49.7:0)
1815 45.2.1.30 10P PSD configuration register (Register 1.50)
45.2.1.30.1 PBO disable (1.50.8)
45.2.1.31 10P downstream data rate configuration (Registers 1.51, 1.52)
1816 45.2.1.32 10P downstream Reed-Solomon configuration (Register 1.53)
45.2.1.32.1 RS codeword length (1.53.0)
45.2.1.33 10P upstream data rate configuration (Registers 1.54, 1.55)
45.2.1.34 10P upstream 10P upstream Reed-Solomon configuration register (Register 1.56)
45.2.1.34.1 RS codeword length (1.56.0)
1817 45.2.1.35 10P tone group registers (Registers 1.57, 1.58)
45.2.1.36 10P tone control parameters (Registers 1.59, 1.60, 1.61, 1.62, 1.63)
1818 45.2.1.36.1 Tone active (1.59.15)
45.2.1.36.2 Tone direction (1.59.14)
45.2.1.36.3 Max SNR margin (1.59.13:5)
45.2.1.36.4 Target SNR margin (1.60.8:0)
45.2.1.36.5 Minimum SNR margin (1.61.8:0)
1819 45.2.1.36.6 PSD level (1.62.8:0)
45.2.1.36.7 USPBO reference (1.63.8:0)
45.2.1.37 10P tone control action register (Register 1.64)
1820 45.2.1.37.1 Refresh tone status (1.64.5)
45.2.1.37.2 Change tone activity (1.64.4)
45.2.1.37.3 Change tone direction (1.64.3)
45.2.1.37.4 Change SNR margin (1.64.2)
45.2.1.37.5 Change PSD level (1.64.1)
45.2.1.37.6 Change USPBO reference PSD (1.64.0)
45.2.1.38 10P tone status registers (Registers 1.65, 1.66, 1.67)
1821 45.2.1.38.1 Refresh status (1.65.15)
45.2.1.38.2 Active (1.65.14)
45.2.1.38.3 Direction (1.65.13)
45.2.1.38.4 RX PSD (1.65.7:0)
45.2.1.38.5 TX PSD (1.66.15:8)
45.2.1.38.6 Bit load (1.66.7:3)
45.2.1.38.7 SNR margin (1.67.9:0)
1822 45.2.1.39 10P outgoing indicator bits status register (Register 1.68)
45.2.1.39.1 LoM (1.68.8)
45.2.1.39.2 lpr (1.68.7)
45.2.1.39.3 po (1.68.6)
1823 45.2.1.39.4 Rdi (1.68.5)
45.2.1.39.5 los (1.68.4)
45.2.1.39.6 fec-s (1.68.1)
45.2.1.39.7 be-s (1.68.0)
45.2.1.40 10P incoming indicator bits status register (Register 1.69)
1824 45.2.1.40.1 LoM (1.69.8)
45.2.1.40.2 Flpr (1.69.7)
45.2.1.40.3 Fpo (1.69.6)
45.2.1.40.4 Rdi (1.69.5)
45.2.1.40.5 Flos (1.69.4)
45.2.1.40.6 Ffec-s (1.69.1)
45.2.1.40.7 Febe-s (1.69.0)
45.2.1.41 10P cyclic extension configuration register (Register 1.70)
1825 45.2.1.42 10P attainable downstream data rate register (Register 1.71)
45.2.1.43 2B general parameter register (Register 1.80)
1826 45.2.1.43.1 PMMS target margin (1.80.14:10)
45.2.1.43.2 Line probing control (1.80.9)
45.2.1.43.3 Noise environment (1.80.8)
45.2.1.43.4 Region (1.80.1:0)
1827 45.2.1.44 2B PMD parameters registers (Registers 1.81 through 1.88)
1829 45.2.1.44.1 Minimum data rate (1.81, 1.83, 1.85, 1.87. Bits 14:8)
45.2.1.44.2 Max data rate (1.81, 1.83, 1.85, 1.87. Bits 6:0)
1830 45.2.1.44.3 Data rate step (1.82, 1.84, 1.86, 1.88. Bits 13:7)
45.2.1.44.4 Power (1.82, 1.84, 1.86, 1.88. Bits 6:2)
45.2.1.44.5 Constellation (1.82, 1.84, 1.86, 1.88. Bits 1:0)
45.2.1.45 2B code violation errors counter (Register 1.89)
45.2.1.46 2B link partner code violations register (Register 1.90)
1831 45.2.1.47 2B errored seconds counter (Register 1.91)
45.2.1.48 2B link partner errored seconds register (Register 1.92)
45.2.1.49 2B severely errored seconds counter (Register 1.93)
45.2.1.50 2B link partner severely errored seconds register (Register 1.94)
1832 45.2.1.51 2B LOSW counter (Register 1.95)
45.2.1.52 2B link partner LOSW register (Register 1.96)
45.2.1.53 2B unavailable seconds counter (Register 1.97)
1833 45.2.1.54 2B link partner unavailable seconds register (Register 1.98)
45.2.1.55 2B state defects register (Register 1.99)
45.2.1.55.1 Segment defect (1.99.15)
45.2.1.55.2 SNR margin defect (1.99.14)
45.2.1.55.3 Loop attenuation defect (1.99.13)
1834 45.2.1.55.4 Loss of sync word (1.99.12)
45.2.1.56 2B link partner state defects register (Register 1.100)
45.2.1.57 2B negotiated constellation register (Register 1.101)
45.2.1.57.1 Negotiated constellation (1.101.1:0)
45.2.1.58 2B extended PMD parameters registers (Registers 1.102 through 1.109)
1836 45.2.1.58.1 Minimum data rate (1.102, 1.104, 1.106, 1.108. Bits 14:8)
45.2.1.58.2 Max data rate (1.102, 1.104, 1.106, 1.108. Bits 6:0)
1837 45.2.1.58.3 Data rate step (1.103, 1.105, 1.107, 1.109. Bits 13:7)
45.2.1.58.4 Power (1.103, 1.105, 1.107, 1.109. Bits 6:2)
45.2.1.58.5 Constellation (1.103, 1.105, 1.107, 1.109. Bits 1:0)
45.2.1.59 10GBASE-T status (Register 1.129)
45.2.1.59.1 LP information valid (1.129.0)
1838 45.2.1.60 10GBASE-T pair swap and polarity register (Register 1.130)
45.2.1.60.1 Pair D polarity (1.130.11)
45.2.1.60.2 Pair C polarity (1.130.10)
45.2.1.60.3 Pair B polarity (1.130.9)
45.2.1.60.4 Pair A polarity (1.130.8)
1839 45.2.1.60.5 MDI/MDI-X connection (1.130.1:0)
45.2.1.61 10GBASE-T TX power backoff and PHY short reach setting (Register 1.131)
45.2.1.61.1 10GBASE-T TX power backoff settings (1.131.15:10)
45.2.1.61.2 PHY short reach mode (1.131.0)
1840 45.2.1.62 10GBASE-T test mode register (Register 1.132)
45.2.1.62.1 Test mode control (1.132.15:13)
45.2.1.62.2 Transmitter test frequencies (1.132.12:10)
45.2.1.63 SNR operating margin channel A register (Register 1.133)
1841 45.2.1.64 SNR operating margin channel B register (Register 1.134)
45.2.1.65 SNR operating margin channel C register (Register 1.135)
45.2.1.66 SNR operating margin channel D register (Register 1.136)
45.2.1.67 Minimum margin channel A register (Register 1.137)
45.2.1.68 Minimum margin channel B register (Register 1.138)
45.2.1.69 Minimum margin channel C register (Register 1.139)
45.2.1.70 Minimum margin channel D register (Register 1.140)
45.2.1.71 RX signal power channel A register (Register 1.141)
1842 45.2.1.72 RX signal power channel B register (Register 1.142)
45.2.1.73 RX signal power channel C register (Register 1.143)
45.2.1.74 RX signal power channel D register (Register 1.144)
45.2.1.75 10GBASE-T skew delay register (Registers 1.145 and 1.146)
1843 45.2.1.76 10GBASE-KR PMD control register (Register 1.150)
45.2.1.76.1 Restart training (1.150.0)
45.2.1.76.2 Training enable (1.150.1)
45.2.1.77 10GBASE-KR PMD status register (Register 1.151)
45.2.1.77.1 Receiver status (1.151.0)
1844 45.2.1.77.2 Frame lock (1.151.1)
45.2.1.77.3 Start-up protocol status (1.151.2)
45.2.1.77.4 Training failure (1.151.3)
45.2.1.78 10GBASE-KR LP coefficient update register (Register 1.152)
45.2.1.78.1 Preset (1.152.13)
45.2.1.78.2 Initialize (1.152.12)
1845 45.2.1.78.3 Coefficient (k) update (1.152.5:0)
45.2.1.79 10GBASE-KR LP status report register (Register 1.153)
1846 45.2.1.79.1 Receiver ready (1.153.15)
45.2.1.79.2 Coefficient (k) status (1.153.5:0)
45.2.1.80 10GBASE-KR LD coefficient update register (Register 1.154)
45.2.1.80.1 Preset (1.154.13)
45.2.1.80.2 Initialize (1.154.12)
1847 45.2.1.80.3 Coefficient (k) update(1.154.5:0)
45.2.1.81 10GBASE-KR LD status report register (Register 1.155)
1848 45.2.1.81.1 Receiver ready (1.155.15)
45.2.1.81.2 Coefficient (k) status (1.155.5:0)
1849 45.2.1.82 1000BASE-KX control register (Register 1.160)
45.2.1.82.1 PMD transmit disable (1.160.0)
45.2.1.83 1000BASE-KX status register (Register 1.161)
1850 45.2.1.83.1 PMD transmit fault ability (1.161.13)
45.2.1.83.2 PMD receive fault ability (1.161.12)
45.2.1.83.3 PMD transmit fault (1.161.11)
45.2.1.83.4 PMD receive fault (1.161.10)
45.2.1.83.5 PMD transmit disable ability (1.161.8)
45.2.1.83.6 1000BASE-KX signal detect (1.161.0)
1851 45.2.1.84 10GBASE-R FEC ability register (Register 1.170)
45.2.1.84.1 10GBASE-R FEC ability (1.170.0)
45.2.1.84.2 10GBASE-R FEC error indication ability (1.170.1)
45.2.1.85 10GBASE-R FEC control register (Register 1.171)
1852 45.2.1.85.1 FEC enable (1.171.0)
45.2.1.85.2 FEC enable error indication (1.171.1)
45.2.1.86 10GBASE-R FEC corrected blocks counter (Register 1.172, 1.173)
45.2.1.87 10GBASE-R FEC uncorrected blocks counter (Register1.174, 1.175)
1853 45.2.2 WIS registers
1854 45.2.2.1 WIS control 1 register (Register 2.0)
45.2.2.1.1 Reset (2.0.15)
45.2.2.1.2 Loopback (2.0.14)
1855 45.2.2.1.3 Low power (2.0.11)
45.2.2.1.4 Speed selection (2.0.13, 2.0.6, and 2.0.5:2)
1856 45.2.2.2 WIS status 1 register (Register 2.1)
45.2.2.2.1 Fault (2.1.7)
45.2.2.2.2 Link status (2.1.2)
45.2.2.2.3 Low-power ability (2.1.1)
45.2.2.3 WIS device identifier (Registers 2.2 and 2.3)
1857 45.2.2.4 WIS speed ability (Register 2.4)
45.2.2.4.1 10G capable (2.4.0)
45.2.2.5 WIS devices in package (Registers 2.5 and 2.6)
45.2.2.6 10G WIS control 2 register (Register 2.7)
1858 45.2.2.6.1 PRBS31 receive test-pattern enable (2.7.5)
45.2.2.6.2 PRBS31 transmit test-pattern enable (2.7.4)
45.2.2.6.3 Test-pattern selection (2.7.3)
45.2.2.6.4 Receive test-pattern enable (2.7.2)
45.2.2.6.5 Transmit test-pattern enable (2.7.1)
45.2.2.6.6 PCS type selection (2.7.0)
45.2.2.7 10G WIS status 2 register (Register 2.8)
45.2.2.7.1 Device present (2.8.15:14)
1859 45.2.2.7.2 PRBS31 pattern testing ability (2.8.1)
45.2.2.7.3 10GBASE-R ability (2.8.0)
45.2.2.8 10G WIS test-pattern error counter register (Register 2.9)
1860 45.2.2.9 WIS package identifier (Registers 2.14 and 2.15)
45.2.2.10 10G WIS status 3 register (Register 2.33)
1861 45.2.2.10.1 SEF (2.33.11)
45.2.2.10.2 Far end PLM-P/LCD-P (2.33.10)
45.2.2.10.3 Far end AIS-P/LOP-P (2.33.9)
45.2.2.10.4 LOF (2.33.7)
1862 45.2.2.10.5 LOS (2.33.6)
45.2.2.10.6 RDI-L (2.33.5)
45.2.2.10.7 AIS-L (2.33.4)
45.2.2.10.8 LCD-P (2.33.3)
45.2.2.10.9 PLM-P (2.33.2)
45.2.2.10.10 AIS-P (2.33.1)
45.2.2.10.11 LOP-P (2.33.0)
1863 45.2.2.11 10G WIS far end path block error count (Register 2.37)
45.2.2.12 10G WIS J1 transmit (Registers 2.39 through 2.46)
1864 45.2.2.13 10G WIS J1 receive (Registers 2.47 through 2.54)
1865 45.2.2.14 10G WIS far end line BIP errors (Registers 2.55 and 2.56)
45.2.2.15 10G WIS line BIP errors (Registers 2.57 and 2.58)
1866 45.2.2.16 10G WIS path block error count (Register 2.59)
45.2.2.16.1 Path block error count (2.59.15:0)
45.2.2.17 10G WIS section BIP error count (Register 2.60)
45.2.2.17.1 Section BIP error count (2.60.15:0)
1867 45.2.2.18 10G WIS J0 transmit (Registers 2.64 through 2.71)
45.2.2.19 10G WIS J0 receive (Registers 2.72 through 2.79)
1868 45.2.3 PCS registers
1870 45.2.3.1 PCS control 1 register (Register 3.0)
45.2.3.1.1 Reset (3.0.15)
1871 45.2.3.1.2 Loopback (3.0.14)
45.2.3.1.3 Low power (3.0.11)
45.2.3.1.4 Speed selection (3.0.13, 3.0.6, 3.0.5:2)
45.2.3.2 PCS status 1 register (Register 3.1)
45.2.3.2.1 Fault (3.1.7)
1872 45.2.3.2.2 PCS receive link status (3.1.2)
45.2.3.2.3 Low-power ability (3.1.1)
45.2.3.3 PCS device identifier (Registers 3.2 and 3.3)
45.2.3.4 PCS speed ability (Register 3.4)
45.2.3.4.1 10G capable (3.4.0)
1873 45.2.3.4.2 10PASS-TS/2BASE-TL capable
45.2.3.5 PCS devices in package (Registers 3.5 and 3.6)
45.2.3.6 10G PCS control 2 register (Register 3.7)
45.2.3.6.1 PCS type selection (3.7.1:0)
1874 45.2.3.7 10G PCS status 2 register (Register 3.8)
45.2.3.7.1 Device present (3.8.15:14)
45.2.3.7.2 Transmit fault (3.8.11)
1875 45.2.3.7.3 Receive fault (3.8.10)
45.2.3.7.4 10GBASE-T capable (3.8.3)
45.2.3.7.5 10GBASE-W capable (3.8.2)
45.2.3.7.6 10GBASE-X capable (3.8.1)
45.2.3.7.7 10GBASE-R capable (3.8.0)
45.2.3.8 PCS package identifier (Registers 3.14 and 3.15)
45.2.3.9 10GBASE-X PCS status register (Register 3.24)
1876 45.2.3.9.1 10GBASE-X receive lane alignment status (3.24.12)
45.2.3.9.2 Pattern testing ability (3.24.11)
45.2.3.9.3 Lane 3 sync (3.24.3)
45.2.3.9.4 Lane 2 sync (3.24.2)
45.2.3.9.5 Lane 1 sync (3.24.1)
1877 45.2.3.9.6 Lane 0 sync (3.24.0)
45.2.3.10 10GBASE-X PCS test control register (Register 3.25)
45.2.3.10.1 Transmit test-pattern enable (3.25.2)
45.2.3.10.2 Test pattern select (3.25.1:0)
45.2.3.11 10GBASE-R PCS and 10GBASE-T PCS status 1 register (Register 3.32)
1878 45.2.3.11.1 10GBASE-R and 10GBASE-T receive link status (3.32.12)
45.2.3.11.2 PRBS9 pattern testing ability (3.32.3)
45.2.3.11.3 PRBS31 pattern testing ability (3.32.2)
45.2.3.11.4 10GBASE-R and 10GBASE-T PCS high BER (3.32.1)
1879 45.2.3.11.5 10GBASE-R and 10GBASE-T PCS block lock (3.32.0)
45.2.3.12 10GBASE-R and 10GBASE-T PCS status 2 register (Register 3.33)
45.2.3.12.1 Latched block lock (3.33.15)
1880 45.2.3.12.2 Latched high BER (3.33.14)
45.2.3.12.3 BER(3.33.13:8)
45.2.3.12.4 Errored blocks (3.33.7:0)
45.2.3.13 10GBASE-R PCS test pattern seed A (Registers 3.34 through 3.37)
1881 45.2.3.14 10GBASE-R PCS test pattern seed B (Registers 3.38 through 3.41)
45.2.3.15 10GBASE-R PCS test-pattern control register (Register 3.42)
45.2.3.15.1 PRBS9 transmit test-pattern enable (3.42.6)
45.2.3.15.2 PRBS31 receive test-pattern enable (3.42.5)
1882 45.2.3.15.3 PRBS31 transmit test-pattern enable (3.42.4)
45.2.3.15.4 Transmit test-pattern enable (3.42.3)
45.2.3.15.5 Receive test-pattern enable (3.42.2)
45.2.3.15.6 Test-pattern select (3.42.1)
1883 45.2.3.15.7 Data pattern select (3.42.0)
45.2.3.16 10GBASE-R PCS test-pattern error counter register (Register 3.43)
45.2.3.17 10P/2B capability register (3.60)
1884 45.2.3.17.1 PAF available (3.60.12)
45.2.3.17.2 Remote PAF supported (3.60.11)
45.2.3.18 10P/2B PCS control register (Register 3.61)
45.2.3.18.1 MII receive during transmit (3.61.15)
45.2.3.18.2 TX_EN and CRS infer a collision (3.61.14)
45.2.3.18.3 PAF enable (3.61.0)
1885 45.2.3.19 10P/2B PME available (Registers 3.62 and 3.63)
45.2.3.20 10P/2B PME aggregate registers (Registers 3.64 and 3.65)
1886 45.2.3.21 10P/2B PAF RX error register (Register 3.66)
45.2.3.22 10P/2B PAF small fragments register (Register 3.67)
1887 45.2.3.23 10P/2B PAF large fragments register (Register 3.68)
45.2.3.24 10P/2B PAF overflow register (Register 3.69)
45.2.3.25 10P/2B PAF bad fragments register (Register 3.70)
1888 45.2.3.26 10P/2B PAF lost fragments register (Register 3.71)
45.2.3.27 10P/2B PAF lost starts of fragments register (Register 3.72)
45.2.3.28 10P/2B PAF lost ends of fragments register (Register 3.73)
45.2.4 PHY XS registers
1889 45.2.4.1 PHY XS control 1 register (Register 4.0)
45.2.4.1.1 Reset (4.0.15)
1890 45.2.4.1.2 Loopback (4.0.14)
1891 45.2.4.1.3 Low power (4.0.11)
45.2.4.1.4 Speed selection (4.0.13, 4.0.6, 4.0.5:2)
45.2.4.2 PHY XS status 1 register (Register 4.1)
45.2.4.2.1 Fault (4.1.7)
1892 45.2.4.2.2 PHY XS transmit link status (4.1.2)
45.2.4.2.3 Low-power ability (4.1.1)
45.2.4.3 PHY XS device identifier (Registers 4.2 and 4.3)
45.2.4.4 PHY XS speed ability (Register 4.4)
45.2.4.4.1 10G capable (4.4.0)
45.2.4.5 PHY XS devices in package (Registers 4.5 and 4.6)
45.2.4.6 PHY XS status 2 register (Register 4.8)
1893 45.2.4.6.1 Device present (4.8.15:14)
45.2.4.6.2 Transmit fault (4.8.11)
45.2.4.6.3 Receive fault (4.8.10)
45.2.4.7 PHY XS package identifier (Registers 4.14 and 4.15)
1894 45.2.4.8 10G PHY XGXS lane status register (Register 4.24)
45.2.4.8.1 PHY XGXS transmit lane alignment status (4.24.12)
45.2.4.8.2 Pattern testing ability (4.24.11)
1895 45.2.4.8.3 PHY XS loopback ability (4.24.10)
45.2.4.8.4 Lane 3 sync (4.24.3)
45.2.4.8.5 Lane 2 sync (4.24.2)
45.2.4.8.6 Lane 1 sync (4.24.1)
45.2.4.8.7 Lane 0 sync (4.24.0)
45.2.4.9 10G PHY XGXS test control register (Register 4.25)
1896 45.2.4.9.1 10G PHY XGXS test-pattern enable (4.25.2)
45.2.4.9.2 10G PHY XGXS test-pattern select (4.25.1:0)
45.2.5 DTE XS registers
1897 45.2.5.1 DTE XS control 1 register (Register 5.0)
45.2.5.1.1 Reset (5.0.15)
1898 45.2.5.1.2 Loopback (5.0.14)
45.2.5.1.3 Low power (5.0.11)
45.2.5.1.4 Speed selection (5.0.13, 5.0.6, 5.0.5:2)
45.2.5.2 DTE XS status 1 register (Register 5.1)
45.2.5.2.1 Fault (5.1.7)
45.2.5.2.2 DTE XS receive link status (5.1.2)
1899 45.2.5.2.3 Low-power ability (5.1.1)
45.2.5.3 DTE XS device identifier (Registers 5.2 and 5.3)
45.2.5.4 DTE XS speed ability (Register 5.4)
1900 45.2.5.4.1 10G capable (5.4.0)
45.2.5.5 DTE XS devices in package (Registers 5.5 and 5.6)
45.2.5.6 DTE XS status 2 register (Register 5.8)
45.2.5.6.1 Device present (5.8.15:14)
45.2.5.6.2 Transmit fault (5.8.11)
1901 45.2.5.6.3 Receive fault (5.8.10)
45.2.5.7 DTE XS package identifier (Registers 5.14 and 5.15)
45.2.5.8 10G DTE XGXS lane status register (Register 5.24)
1902 45.2.5.8.1 DTE XGXS receive lane alignment status (5.24.12)
45.2.5.8.2 Pattern testing ability (5.24.11)
45.2.5.8.3 Lane 3 sync (5.24.3)
45.2.5.8.4 Lane 2 sync (5.24.2)
45.2.5.8.5 Lane 1 sync (5.24.1)
45.2.5.8.6 Lane 0 sync (5.24.0)
45.2.5.9 10G DTE XGXS test control register (Register 5.25)
1903 45.2.5.9.1 10G DTE XGXS test-pattern enable (5.25.2)
45.2.5.9.2 10G DTE XGXS test-pattern select (5.25.1:0)
45.2.6 TC registers
1904 45.2.6.1 TC control register (Register 6.0)
45.2.6.1.1 Reset (6.0.15)
1905 45.2.6.1.2 Speed selection (6.0.13, 6.0.6, 6.0.5:2)
45.2.6.2 TC device identifier (Registers 6.2 and 6.3)
45.2.6.3 TC speed ability (Register 6.4)
45.2.6.3.1 10PASS-TS/2BASE-TL capable (6.4.1)
45.2.6.4 TC devices in package registers (Registers 6.5, 6.6)
1906 45.2.6.5 TC package identifier registers (Registers 6.14, 6.15)
45.2.6.6 10P/2B aggregation discovery control register (Register 6.16)
45.2.6.6.1 Discovery operation (6.16.1:0)
1907 45.2.6.7 10P/2B aggregation and discovery status register (Register 6.17)
45.2.6.7.1 Link partner aggregate operation result (6.17.1)
45.2.6.7.2 Discovery operation result (6.17.0)
1908 45.2.6.8 10P/2B aggregation discovery code (Registers 6.18, 6.19, 6.20)
45.2.6.9 10P/2B link partner PME aggregate control register (Register 6.21)
1909 45.2.6.9.1 Link partner aggregate operation (1.21.1:0)
45.2.6.10 10P/2B link partner PME aggregate data (Registers 6.22, 6.23)
45.2.6.11 10P/2B TC CRC error register (Register 6.24)
1910 45.2.6.12 10P/2B TPS-TC coding violations counter (Registers 6.25, 6.26)
45.2.6.13 10P/2B TC indications register (Register 6.27)
45.2.6.13.1 Local TC synchronized (6.27.8)
1911 45.2.6.13.2 Remote TC synchronized (6.27.0)
45.2.7 Auto-Negotiation registers
45.2.7.1 AN control register (Register 7.0)
1912 45.2.7.1.1 AN reset (7.0.15)
45.2.7.1.2 Extended next page control (7.0.13)
45.2.7.1.3 Auto-Negotiation enable (7.0.12)
1913 45.2.7.1.4 Restart Auto-Negotiation (7.0.9)
45.2.7.2 AN status (Register 7.1)
45.2.7.2.1 Parallel detection fault (7.1.9)
1914 45.2.7.2.2 Extended next page status (7.1.7)
45.2.7.2.3 Page received (7.1.6)
45.2.7.2.4 Auto-Negotiation complete (7.1.5)
45.2.7.2.5 Remote fault (7.1.4)
45.2.7.2.6 Auto-Negotiation ability (7.1.3)
45.2.7.2.7 Link status (7.1.2)
1915 45.2.7.2.8 Link partner Auto-Negotiation ability (7.1.0)
45.2.7.3 Auto-Negotiation device identifier (Registers 7.2 and 7.3)
45.2.7.4 AN devices in package (Registers 7.5 and 7.6)
45.2.7.5 AN package identifier (Registers 7.14 and 7.15)
45.2.7.6 AN advertisement register (7.16, 7.17, and 7.18)
1916 45.2.7.7 AN LP base page ability register (7.19, 7.20, and 7.21)
1917 45.2.7.8 AN XNP transmit register (7.22, 7.23, and 7.24)
1918 45.2.7.9 AN LP XNP ability register (7.25, 7.26, and 7.27)
1919 45.2.7.10 10GBASE-T AN control register (Register 7.32)
45.2.7.10.1 MASTER-SLAVE manual config enable (7.32.15)
45.2.7.10.2 MASTER-SLAVE config value (7.32.14)
1920 45.2.7.10.3 Port type (7.32.13)
45.2.7.10.4 10GBASE-T capability (7.32.12)
45.2.7.10.5 LD PMA training reset request (7.32.2)
45.2.7.10.6 LD loop timing ability (7.32.0)
1921 45.2.7.11 10GBASE-T AN status register (Register 7.33)
45.2.7.11.1 MASTER-SLAVE configuration fault (7.33.15)
45.2.7.11.2 MASTER-SLAVE configuration resolution (7.33.14)
1922 45.2.7.11.3 Local receiver status (7.33.13)
45.2.7.11.4 Remote receiver status (7.33.12)
45.2.7.11.5 Link partner 10GBASE-T capability (7.33.11)
45.2.7.11.6 Link partner loop timing ability (7.33.10)
45.2.7.11.7 Link partner PMA training reset request (7.33.9)
45.2.7.12 Backplane Ethernet status (Register 7.48)
1923 45.2.7.12.1 10GBASE-KR FEC negotiated (7.48.4)
45.2.7.12.2 Negotiated Port Type (7.48.1, 7.48.2, 7.48.3)
45.2.7.12.3 Backplane Ethernet AN ability (7.48.0)
45.2.8 Clause 22 extension registers
45.2.8.1 Clause 22 extension devices in package registers (Registers 29.5, 29.6)
1924 45.2.8.2 FEC capability register (Register 29.7)
45.2.8.2.1 FEC capable (29.7.0)
45.2.8.3 FEC control register (Register 29.8)
45.2.8.3.1 FEC enable (29.8.0)
45.2.8.4 FEC buffer head coding violation counter (Register 29.9)
1925 45.2.8.5 FEC corrected blocks counter (Register 29.10)
45.2.8.6 FEC uncorrected blocks counter (Register 29.11)
45.2.9 Vendor specific MMD 1 registers
1926 45.2.9.1 Vendor specific MMD 1 device identifier (Registers 30.2 and 30.3)
45.2.9.2 Vendor specific MMD 1 status register (Register 30.8)
45.2.9.2.1 Device present (30.8.15:14)
45.2.9.3 Vendor specific MMD 1 package identifier (Registers 30.14 and 30.15)
1927 45.2.10 Vendor specific MMD 2 registers
45.2.10.1 Vendor specific MMD 2 device identifier (Registers 31.2 and 31.3)
45.2.10.2 Vendor specific MMD 2 status register (Register 31.8)
1928 45.2.10.2.1 Device present (31.8.15:14)
45.2.10.3 Vendor specific MMD 2 package identifier (Registers 31.14 and 31.15)
45.3 Management frame structure
1929 45.3.1 IDLE (idle condition)
45.3.2 PRE (preamble)
45.3.3 ST (start of frame)
45.3.4 OP (operation code)
45.3.5 PRTAD (port address)
45.3.6 DEVAD (device address)
45.3.7 TA (turnaround)
1930 45.3.8 ADDRESS / DATA
45.4 Electrical interface
45.4.1 Electrical specification
45.4.2 Timing specification
1932 45.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 45, MDIO interface
45.5.1 Introduction
45.5.2 Identification
45.5.2.1 Implementation identification
45.5.2.2 Protocol summary
1933 45.5.2.3 Major capabilities/options
45.5.3 PICS proforma tables for the Management Data Input Output (MDIO) interface
45.5.3.1 MDIO signal functional specifications
1934 45.5.3.2 PMA/PMD MMD options
1935 45.5.3.3 PMA/PMD management functions
1941 45.5.3.4 WIS options
45.5.3.5 WIS management functions
1945 45.5.3.6 PCS options
45.5.3.7 PCS management functions
1950 45.5.3.8 Auto-Negotiation options
45.5.3.9 Auto-Negotiation management functions
1953 45.5.3.10 PHY XS options
45.5.3.11 PHY XS management functions
1955 45.5.3.12 DTE XS options
45.5.3.13 DTE XS management functions
1957 45.5.3.14 Vendor specific MMD 1 management functions
1958 45.5.3.15 Vendor specific MMD 2 management functions
45.5.3.16 Management frame structure
1959 45.5.3.17 TC management functions
1961 45.5.3.18 Clause 22 extension options
45.5.3.19 Clause 22 extension management functions
1962 45.5.3.20 Signal timing characteristics
45.5.3.21 Electrical characteristics
1963 46. Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and 10 Gigabit Media Independent Interface (XGMII)
46.1 Overview
1964 46.1.1 Summary of major concepts
46.1.2 Application
46.1.3 Rate of operation
46.1.4 Delay constraints
1965 46.1.5 Allocation of functions
46.1.6 XGMII structure
1966 46.1.7 Mapping of XGMII signals to PLS service primitives
46.1.7.1 Mapping of PLS_DATA.request
46.1.7.1.1 Function
46.1.7.1.2 Semantics of the service primitive
46.1.7.1.3 When generated
46.1.7.1.4 Effect of receipt
1967 46.1.7.2 Mapping of PLS_DATA.indication
46.1.7.2.1 Function
46.1.7.2.2 Semantics of the service primitive
46.1.7.2.3 When generated
46.1.7.2.4 Effect of receipt
46.1.7.3 Mapping of PLS_CARRIER.indication
46.1.7.4 Mapping of PLS_SIGNAL.indication
1968 46.1.7.5 Mapping of PLS_DATA_VALID.indication
46.1.7.5.1 Function
46.1.7.5.2 Semantics of the service primitive
46.1.7.5.3 When generated
46.1.7.5.4 Effect of receipt
46.2 XGMII data stream
1969 46.2.1 Inter-frame
46.2.2 Preamble and start of frame delimiter
1970 46.2.3 Data
46.2.4 End of frame delimiter
46.2.5 Definition of Start of Packet and End of Packet Delimiters
46.3 XGMII functional specifications
46.3.1 Transmit
46.3.1.1 TX_CLK (10 Gb/s transmit clock)
1971 46.3.1.2 TXC (transmit control)
46.3.1.3 TXD (transmit data)
1972 46.3.1.4 Start control character alignment
1973 46.3.2 Receive
46.3.2.1 RX_CLK (receive clock)
46.3.2.2 RXC (receive control)
1975 46.3.2.3 RXD (receive data)
46.3.3 Error and fault handling
46.3.3.1 Response to error indications by the XGMII
1976 46.3.3.2 Conditions for generation of transmit Error control characters
46.3.3.3 Response to received invalid frame sequences
46.3.4 Link fault signaling
1977 46.3.4.1 Conventions
46.3.4.2 Variables and counters
1978 46.3.4.3 State Diagram
1979 46.4 XGMII electrical characteristics
1981 46.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 46, Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and 10 Gigabit Media Independent Interface (XGMII)
46.5.1 Introduction
46.5.2 Identification
46.5.2.1 Implementation identification
46.5.2.2 Protocol summary
1982 46.5.2.3 Major capabilities/options
46.5.3 PICS proforma Tables for Reconciliation Sublayer and 10 Gigabit Media Independent Interface
46.5.3.1 General
46.5.3.2 Mapping of PLS service primitives
1983 46.5.3.3 Data stream structure
1984 46.5.3.4 XGMII signal functional specifications
1985 46.5.3.5 Link fault signaling state diagram
46.5.3.6 Electrical characteristics
1987 47. XGMII Extender Sublayer (XGXS) and 10 Gigabit Attachment Unit Interface (XAUI)
47.1 Overview
1988 47.1.1 Summary of major concepts
47.1.2 Application
47.1.3 Rate of operation
47.1.4 Allocation of functions
47.2 Functional specifications
1989 47.2.1 PCS and PMA functionality
47.2.2 Delay constraints
47.3 XAUI Electrical characteristics
1990 47.3.1 Signal levels
47.3.2 Signal paths
47.3.3 Driver characteristics
47.3.3.1 Load
47.3.3.2 Amplitude and swing
1991 47.3.3.3 Transition time
47.3.3.4 Output impedance
47.3.3.5 Driver template and jitter
1992 47.3.4 Receiver characteristics
47.3.4.1 Bit error ratio
47.3.4.2 Reference input signals
1993 47.3.4.3 Input signal amplitude
47.3.4.4 AC coupling
47.3.4.5 Input impedance
47.3.4.6 Jitter tolerance
1994 47.3.5 Interconnect characteristics
47.3.5.1 Characteristic impedance
1995 47.3.5.2 Connector impedance
47.4 Electrical measurement requirements
47.4.1 Compliance interconnect definition
47.4.2 Eye template measurements
1996 47.4.3 Jitter test requirements
47.4.3.1 Transmit jitter
47.4.3.2 Jitter tolerance
47.5 Environmental specifications
1997 47.6 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 47, XGMII Extender (XGMII) and 10 Gigabit Attachment Unit Interface (XAUI)
47.6.1 Introduction
47.6.2 Identification
47.6.2.1 Implementation identification
47.6.2.2 Protocol summary
1998 47.6.3 Major capabilities/options
47.6.4 PICS Proforma tables for XGXS and XAUI
47.6.4.1 Compatibility considerations
47.6.4.2 XGXS and XAUI functions
47.6.4.3 Electrical characteristics
2001 48. Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) and Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer, type 10GBASE-X
48.1 Overview
48.1.1 Objectives
2002 48.1.2 Relationship of 10GBASE-X to other standards
48.1.3 Summary of 10GBASE-X sublayers
48.1.3.1 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
2003 48.1.3.2 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
48.1.3.3 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer
48.1.4 Rate of operation
48.1.5 Allocation of functions
48.1.6 Inter-sublayer interfaces
2004 48.1.7 Functional block diagram
48.1.8 Special symbols
2005 48.2 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
48.2.1 PCS service interface (XGMII)
48.2.2 Functions within the PCS
2006 48.2.3 Use of code-groups
2008 48.2.4 Ordered_sets and special code-groups
48.2.4.1 Data (/D/)
48.2.4.2 Idle (||I||)
2011 48.2.4.2.1 Sync ||K||
48.2.4.2.2 Align ||A||
48.2.4.2.3 Skip ||R||
2012 48.2.4.3 Encapsulation
48.2.4.3.1 Start ||S||
48.2.4.3.2 Terminate ||T||
48.2.4.4 Error /E/
2013 48.2.4.5 Link status
48.2.4.5.1 Sequence ||Q||
48.2.5 Management function requirements
2014 48.2.6 Detailed functions and state diagrams
48.2.6.1 State variables
48.2.6.1.1 Notation conventions
2015 48.2.6.1.2 Constants
2016 48.2.6.1.3 Variables
2019 48.2.6.1.4 Functions
2020 48.2.6.1.5 Counters
48.2.6.1.6 Messages
48.2.6.2 State diagrams
48.2.6.2.1 Transmit
2021 48.2.6.2.2 Synchronization
48.2.6.2.3 Deskew
2025 48.2.6.2.4 Receive
48.2.6.3 Initialization process
2026 48.2.6.4 Link status reporting
48.2.6.4.1 Link status detection
48.2.6.4.2 Link status signaling
48.2.6.4.3 Link status messages
48.2.7 Auto-Negotiation for Backplane Ethernet
48.3 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
48.3.1 Functions within the PMA
2027 48.3.1.1 PMA transmit process
48.3.1.2 PMA receive process
48.3.2 Service interface
48.3.2.1 PMA_UNITDATA.request
2028 48.3.2.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
48.3.2.1.2 When generated
48.3.2.1.3 Effect of receipt
48.3.2.2 PMA_UNITDATA.indication
48.3.2.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
48.3.2.2.2 When generated
48.3.2.2.3 Effect of receipt
48.3.3 Loopback mode
2029 48.3.3.1 Receiver considerations
48.3.3.2 Transmitter considerations
48.3.4 Test functions
48.4 Compatibility considerations
48.5 Delay constraints
48.6 Environmental specifications
2030 48.7 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) and Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer, type 10GBASE-X
48.7.1 Introduction
48.7.2 Identification
48.7.2.1 Implementation identification
48.7.2.2 Protocol summary
2031 48.7.3 Major capabilities/options
48.7.4 PICS proforma tables for the PCS and PMA sublayer, type 10GBASE-X
48.7.4.1 Compatibility considerations
48.7.4.2 PCS functions
2032 48.7.4.3 PMA Functions
48.7.4.4 Interface functions
2033 49. Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) for 64B/66B, type 10GBASE-R
49.1 Overview
49.1.1 Scope
49.1.2 Objectives
49.1.3 Relationship of 10GBASE-R to other standards
2034 49.1.4 Summary of 10GBASE-R and 10GBASE-W sublayers
49.1.4.1 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
2035 49.1.4.2 WAN Interface Sublayer (WIS)
49.1.4.3 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
49.1.4.4 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer
49.1.4.5 Bit ordering across 10GBASE-R and 10GBASE-W sublayers.
2036 49.1.5 Inter-sublayer interfaces
2037 49.1.6 Functional block diagram
2038 49.2 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
49.2.1 PCS service interface (XGMII)
49.2.2 Functions within the PCS
2039 49.2.3 Use of blocks
49.2.4 64B/66B transmission code
49.2.4.1 Notation conventions
2040 49.2.4.2 Transmission order
49.2.4.3 Block structure
2042 49.2.4.4 Control codes
49.2.4.5 Ordered sets
2043 49.2.4.6 Valid and invalid blocks
49.2.4.7 Idle (/I/)
2044 49.2.4.8 Start (/S/)
49.2.4.9 Terminate (/T/)
49.2.4.10 ordered_set (/O/)
49.2.4.11 Error (/E/)
49.2.5 Transmit process
2045 49.2.6 Scrambler
49.2.7 Gearbox
49.2.8 Test-pattern generators
2046 49.2.9 Block synchronization
2047 49.2.10 Descrambler
49.2.11 Receive process
49.2.12 Test-pattern checker
2048 49.2.13 Detailed functions and state diagrams
49.2.13.1 State diagram conventions
2049 49.2.13.2 State variables
49.2.13.2.1 Constants
49.2.13.2.2 Variables
2050 49.2.13.2.3 Functions
2051 49.2.13.2.4 Counters
49.2.13.2.5 Timers
49.2.13.3 State diagrams
2052 49.2.14 PCS Management
49.2.14.1 Status
49.2.14.2 Counters
49.2.14.3 Test mode control
2053 49.2.14.4 Loopback
49.2.15 Delay constraints
2054 49.2.16 Auto-Negotiation for Backplane Ethernet
2057 49.3 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 49, Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) type 10GBASE-R
49.3.1 Introduction
49.3.2 Identification
49.3.2.1 Implementation identification
49.3.2.2 Protocol summary
2058 49.3.3 Major Capabilities/Options
49.3.4 PICS Proforma Tables for PCS, type 10GBASE-R
49.3.4.1 Coding rules
2059 49.3.4.2 Scrambler and Descrambler
49.3.5 Test-pattern modes
2060 49.3.5.1 Bit order
49.3.6 Management
49.3.6.1 State diagrams
2061 49.3.6.2 WIS
49.3.6.3 Loopback
49.3.6.4 Delay Constraints
49.3.6.5 Auto-Negotiation for Backplane Ethernet functions
2063 50. WAN Interface Sublayer (WIS), type 10GBASE-W
50.1 Overview
50.1.1 Scope
2064 50.1.2 Objectives
50.1.3 Relationship to other sublayers
2065 50.1.4 Summary of functions
50.1.5 Sublayer interfaces
2066 50.1.6 Functional block diagram
50.1.7 Notational conventions
50.2 WIS Service Interface
2067 50.2.1 WIS_UNITDATA.request
50.2.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
50.2.1.2 When generated
50.2.1.3 Effect of receipt
50.2.2 WIS_UNITDATA.indication
50.2.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
2068 50.2.2.2 When generated
50.2.2.3 Effect of receipt
50.2.3 WIS_SIGNAL.request
50.2.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
50.2.3.2 When generated
50.2.3.3 Effect of receipt
50.2.4 WIS_SIGNAL.indication
50.2.4.1 Semantics of the service primitive
2069 50.2.4.2 When generated
50.2.4.3 Effect of receipt
50.3 Functions within the WIS
2070 50.3.1 Payload mapping and data-unit delineation
2071 50.3.1.1 Transmit payload mapping
2072 50.3.1.2 Receive payload mapping
50.3.2 WIS frame generation
2073 50.3.2.1 Transmit Path Overhead insertion
2074 50.3.2.2 Transmit Line Overhead insertion
2075 50.3.2.3 Transmit Section Overhead insertion
2076 50.3.2.4 Receive Path, Line, and Section Overhead extraction
2077 50.3.2.5 Fault processing
2078 50.3.3 Scrambling
2079 50.3.3.1 Scrambler polynomial
50.3.3.2 Scrambler bit ordering
50.3.4 Octet and frame delineation
50.3.5 Error propagation
2080 50.3.5.1 Propagated errors
50.3.5.2 Error propagation timing
50.3.5.3 Loss of Code-group Delineation
50.3.6 Mapping between WIS and PMA
2081 50.3.7 WIS data delay constraints
2082 50.3.8 WIS test-pattern generator and checker
50.3.8.1 Square wave test pattern
50.3.8.2 PRBS31 test pattern
2083 50.3.8.3 Mixed-frequency test pattern
2084 50.3.8.3.1 Test Signal Structure (TSS)
2085 50.3.8.3.2 Continuous Identical Digits
50.3.9 Loopback
50.3.10 Link status
50.3.11 Management interface
2086 50.3.11.1 Management registers
50.3.11.2 WIS managed object class
50.3.11.3 Management support objects
2087 50.4 Synchronization state diagram
50.4.1 State diagram variables
50.4.1.1 Constants
2088 50.4.1.2 Variables
50.4.1.3 Functions
2089 50.4.1.4 Counters
50.4.2 State diagram
2091 50.4.3 Parameter values
50.5 Environmental specifications
2093 50.6 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 50, WAN Interface Sublayer (WIS), type 10GBASE-W
50.6.1 Introduction
50.6.2 Identification
50.6.2.1 Implementation identification
50.6.2.2 Protocol summary
2094 50.6.3 Major capabilities/options
50.6.4 PICS proforma tables for the WAN Interface Sublayer (WIS), type 10GBASE-W
50.6.4.1 Compatibility considerations
50.6.4.2 WIS transmit functions
2095 50.6.4.3 WIS receive functions
2096 50.6.4.4 State diagrams
2097 50.6.4.5 Error notification
50.6.4.6 Management registers and functions
2098 50.6.4.7 WIS test-pattern generator and checker
2099 51. Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer, type Serial
51.1 Overview
51.1.1 Scope
51.1.2 Summary of functions
2100 51.2 PMA Service Interface
51.2.1 PMA_UNITDATA.request
51.2.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
51.2.1.2 When generated
51.2.1.3 Effect of receipt
2101 51.2.2 PMA_UNITDATA.indication
51.2.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
51.2.2.2 When generated
51.2.2.3 Effect of receipt
51.2.3 PMA_SIGNAL.indication
51.2.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
51.2.3.2 When generated
51.2.3.3 Effect of receipt
51.3 Functions within the PMA
2102 51.3.1 PMA transmit function
51.3.2 PMA receive function
51.3.3 Delay Constraints
51.4 Sixteen-Bit Interface (XSBI)
2104 51.4.1 Required signals
2106 51.4.2 Optional Signals
51.5 General electrical characteristics of the XSBI
51.5.1 DC characteristics
51.5.2 Valid signal levels
51.5.3 Rise and fall time definition
2108 51.5.4 Output load
51.6 XSBI transmit interface electrical characteristics
51.6.1 XSBI transmit interface timing
51.6.1.1 PMA client output timing
2109 51.6.1.2 PMA input timing
2110 51.6.2 XSBI PMA_TX_CLK and PMA_TXCLK_SRC Specification
51.7 XSBI receive interface electrical characteristics
51.7.1 XSBI receive interface timing
2111 51.7.1.1 PMA output timing
2112 51.7.1.2 PMA client input timing
51.7.2 XSBI PMA_RX_CLK specification
51.8 PMA loopback mode (optional)
2113 51.9 Environmental specifications
2114 51.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 51, Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer, type Serial
51.10.1 Introduction
51.10.2 Identification
51.10.2.1 Implementation identification
51.10.2.2 Protocol summary
2115 51.10.3 Major capabilities/options
51.10.4 PICS proforma tables for the PMA Interface Sublayer, type Serial
51.10.4.1 Compatibility considerations
51.10.4.2 PMA transmit functions
2116 51.10.4.3 PMA receive functions
51.10.4.4 PMA delay constraints
2117 52. Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-S (short wavelength serial), 10GBASE-L (long wavelength serial), and 10GBASE-E (extra long wavelength serial)
52.1 Overview
2118 52.1.1 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer service interface
52.1.1.1 PMD_UNITDATA.request
2119 52.1.1.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
52.1.1.1.2 When generated
52.1.1.1.3 Effect of receipt
52.1.1.2 PMD_UNITDATA.indication
52.1.1.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
52.1.1.2.2 When generated
52.1.1.2.3 Effect of receipt
52.1.1.3 PMD_SIGNAL.indication
52.1.1.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
2120 52.1.1.3.2 When generated
52.1.1.3.3 Effect of receipt
52.2 Delay constraints
52.3 PMD MDIO function mapping
2121 52.4 PMD functional specifications
52.4.1 PMD block diagram
52.4.2 PMD Transmit function
52.4.3 PMD Receive function
52.4.4 PMD Signal Detect function
2122 52.4.5 PMD_reset function
52.4.6 PMD_fault function
52.4.7 PMD_global_transmit_disable function
2123 52.4.8 PMD_transmit_fault function
52.4.9 PMD_receive_fault function
52.5 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-S
2124 52.5.1 10GBASE-S transmitter optical specifications
2126 52.5.2 10GBASE-S receive optical specifications
52.5.3 10GBASE-S link power budgets (informative)
2127 52.6 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-L
52.6.1 10GBASE-L transmitter optical specifications
2129 52.6.2 10GBASE-L receive optical specifications
52.6.3 10GBASE-L link power budgets (informative)
2130 52.7 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-E
2131 52.7.1 10GBASE-E transmitter optical specifications
2132 52.7.2 10GBASE-E receive optical specifications
52.7.3 10GBASE-E link power budgets (informative)
52.8 Jitter specifications for 10GBASE-R and 10GBASE-W
2133 52.8.1 Sinusoidal jitter for receiver conformance test
2134 52.9 Optical measurement requirements
52.9.1 Test patterns
52.9.1.1 Test-pattern definition
2136 52.9.1.2 Square wave pattern definition
52.9.2 Center wavelength and spectral width measurements
52.9.3 Average optical power measurements
52.9.4 Extinction ratio measurements
52.9.5 Optical modulation amplitude (OMA) test procedure
2137 52.9.6 Relative intensity noise optical modulation amplitude (RINxOMA) measuring procedure
52.9.6.1 General test description
52.9.6.2 Component descriptions
2138 52.9.6.3 Test Procedure
2139 52.9.7 Transmitter optical waveform
2140 52.9.8 Receiver sensitivity measurements
2141 52.9.9 Stressed receiver conformance test
52.9.9.1 Stressed receiver conformance test block diagram
2143 52.9.9.2 Parameter definitions
2144 52.9.9.3 Stressed receiver conformance test signal characteristics and calibration
2145 52.9.9.4 Stressed receiver conformance test procedure
2146 52.9.10 Transmitter and dispersion penalty measurement
52.9.10.1 Reference transmitter requirements
52.9.10.2 Channel requirements
2147 52.9.10.3 Reference receiver requirements
52.9.10.4 Test procedure
2148 52.9.11 Measurement of the receiver 3 dB electrical upper cutoff frequency
2149 52.10 Environmental specifications
52.10.1 General safety
52.10.2 Laser safety
52.10.3 Installation
52.11 Environment
52.11.1 Electromagnetic emission
2150 52.11.2 Temperature, humidity, and handling
52.12 PMD labeling requirements
52.13 Fiber optic cabling model
2151 52.14 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling (channel)
52.14.1 Optical fiber and cable
52.14.2 Optical fiber connection
2152 52.14.2.1 Connection insertion loss
52.14.2.2 Maximum discrete reflectance
52.14.3 10GBASE-E attenuator management
2153 52.14.4 Medium Dependent Interface (MDI) requirements
2154 52.15 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 52, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-S (short wavelength serial), 10GBASE-L (long wavelength serial), and 10GBASE-E (extra long w…
52.15.1 Introduction
52.15.2 Identification
52.15.2.1 Implementation identification
52.15.2.2 Protocol summary
2155 52.15.2.3 Major capabilities/options
2156 52.15.3 PICS proforma tables for Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, types 10GBASE-R and 10GBASE-W
52.15.3.1 PMD functional specifications
52.15.3.2 Management functions
2157 52.15.3.3 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-SR
52.15.3.4 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-SW
52.15.3.5 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-LR
2158 52.15.3.6 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-LW
52.15.3.7 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-ER
52.15.3.8 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-EW
2159 52.15.3.9 Optical measurement requirements
52.15.3.10 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling and MDI
2160 52.15.3.11 Environmental specifications
52.15.3.12 Environment
2161 53. Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-LX4
53.1 Overview
53.1.1 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) service interface
53.1.2 PMD_UNITDATA.request
2162 53.1.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
53.1.2.2 When generated
53.1.2.3 Effect of Receipt
53.1.3 PMD_UNITDATA.indication
53.1.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
2163 53.1.3.2 When generated
53.1.3.3 Effect of receipt
53.1.4 PMD_SIGNAL.indication
53.1.4.1 Semantics of the service primitive
53.1.4.2 When generated
53.1.4.3 Effect of receipt
53.2 Delay constraints
53.3 PMD MDIO function mapping
2164 53.4 PMD functional specifications
53.4.1 PMD block diagram
2165 53.4.2 PMD transmit function
2166 53.4.3 PMD receive function
53.4.4 Global PMD signal detect function
53.4.5 PMD lane by lane signal detect function
2167 53.4.6 PMD reset function
53.4.7 Global PMD transmit disable function
53.4.8 PMD lane by lane transmit disable function
53.4.9 PMD fault function
53.4.10 PMD transmit fault function (optional)
53.4.11 PMD receive fault function (optional)
53.5 Wavelength-division multiplexed-lane assignments
53.6 Operating ranges for 10GBASE-LX4 PMD
2168 53.7 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-LX4
53.7.1 Transmitter optical specifications
2170 53.7.2 Receive optical specifications
53.7.3 Worst case 10GBASE-LX4 link power budget and penalties (informative)
53.8 Jitter specifications for each lane of the 10GBASE-LX4 PMD
53.8.1 Transmit jitter specification
2172 53.8.1.1 Channel requirements for transmit jitter testing
53.8.1.2 Test pattern requirements for transmit jitter testing
53.8.2 Receive jitter tolerance specification
53.8.2.1 Input jitter for receiver jitter test
2173 53.8.2.2 Added sinusoidal jitter for receiver jitter test
2174 53.9 Optical measurement requirements
53.9.1 Wavelength range measurements
2175 53.9.2 Optical power measurements
53.9.3 Source spectral window measurements
53.9.4 Extinction ratio measurements
53.9.5 Optical Modulation Amplitude (OMA) measurements
53.9.6 Relative Intensity Noise [RIN12(OMA)]
53.9.7 Transmitter optical waveform (transmit eye)
2177 53.9.8 Transmit rise/fall characteristics
53.9.9 Receive sensitivity measurements
53.9.10 Transmitter jitter conformance (per lane)
53.9.10.1 Block diagram and general description of test set up
2178 53.9.10.2 Channel requirements for transmit jitter testing
2179 53.9.10.3 Transmit jitter test procedure
53.9.11 Receive sensitivity measurements
53.9.12 Stressed receiver conformance test
53.9.12.1 Block diagram of stressed receiver tolerance test set up
2180 53.9.12.2 Stressed receiver conformance test procedure
53.9.12.3 Characterization of receiver input signal
2181 53.9.12.4 Jitter tolerance test procedure
53.9.13 Measurement of the receiver 3 dB electrical upper cutoff frequency
2182 53.9.14 Conformance test signal at TP3 for receiver testing
2184 53.9.15 Receiver test suite for WDM conformance testing
2186 53.10 Environmental specifications
53.10.1 General safety
53.10.2 Laser safety
2187 53.10.3 Installation
53.11 Environment
53.11.1 Electromagnetic emission
53.11.2 Temperature, humidity, and handling
53.12 PMD labeling requirements
2188 53.13 Fiber optic cabling model
53.14 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling (channel)
53.14.1 Optical fiber and cable
2189 53.14.2 Optical fiber connection
53.14.2.1 Connection insertion loss
2190 53.14.2.2 Connection return loss
53.14.3 Medium Dependent Interface (MDI)
2191 53.15 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 53, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-LX4
53.15.1 Introduction
53.15.2 Identification
53.15.2.1 Implementation identification
53.15.2.2 Protocol summary
2192 53.15.3 Major capabilities/options
2193 53.15.4 PICS proforma tables for 10GBASE-LX4 and baseband medium
53.15.4.1 PMD Functional specifications
2194 53.15.4.2 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 10GBASE-LX4
53.15.4.3 Management functions
2195 53.15.4.4 Jitter specifications
2196 53.15.4.5 Optical measurement requirements
2199 53.15.4.6 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling
2201 54. Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-CX4
54.1 Overview
2202 54.2 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) service interface
54.3 Delay constraints
54.4 PMD MDIO function mapping
54.5 PMD functional specifications
54.5.1 Link block diagram
2203 54.5.2 PMD Transmit function
54.5.3 PMD Receive function
54.5.4 Global PMD signal detect function
2204 54.5.5 PMD lane-by-lane signal detect function
54.5.6 Global PMD transmit disable function
54.5.7 PMD lane-by-lane transmit disable function
2205 54.5.8 Loopback mode
54.5.9 PMD fault function
54.5.10 PMD transmit fault function
54.5.11 PMD receive fault function
54.6 MDI Electrical specifications for 10GBASE-CX4
54.6.1 Signal levels
2206 54.6.2 Signal paths
54.6.3 Transmitter characteristics
2207 54.6.3.1 Test fixtures
54.6.3.2 Test-fixture impedance
54.6.3.3 Signaling speed range
2208 54.6.3.4 Output amplitude
2209 54.6.3.5 Output return loss
2210 54.6.3.6 Differential output template
2211 54.6.3.7 Transition time
54.6.3.8 Transmit jitter
54.6.3.9 Transmit jitter test requirements
2212 54.6.4 Receiver characteristics
54.6.4.1 Bit error ratio
54.6.4.2 Signaling speed range
54.6.4.3 AC-coupling
54.6.4.4 Input signal amplitude
2213 54.6.4.5 Input return loss
54.7 Cable assembly characteristics
2214 54.7.1 Characteristic impedance and reference impedance
54.7.2 Cable assembly insertion loss
2215 54.7.3 Cable assembly return loss
54.7.4 Near-End Crosstalk (NEXT)
54.7.4.1 Differential Near-End Crosstalk
2216 54.7.4.2 Multiple Disturber Near-End Crosstalk (MDNEXT)
2217 54.7.5 Far-End Crosstalk (FEXT)
54.7.5.1 Equal Level Far-End Crosstalk (ELFEXT) loss
54.7.5.2 Multiple Disturber Equal Level Far-End Crosstalk (MDELFEXT) loss
2218 54.7.6 Shielding
54.7.7 Crossover function
2219 54.8 MDI specification
54.8.1 MDI connectors
2220 54.8.2 Connector pin assignments
54.9 Environmental specifications
2221 54.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 54, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-CX4
54.10.1 Introduction
54.10.2 Identification
54.10.2.1 Implementation identification
54.10.2.2 Protocol summary
2222 54.10.3 PICS proforma tables for 10GBASE-CX4 and baseband medium
54.10.4 Major capabilities/options
2223 54.10.4.1 PMD Functional specifications
2224 54.10.4.2 Management functions
2225 54.10.4.3 Transmitter specifications
2226 54.10.4.4 Receiver specifications
54.10.4.5 Cable assembly specifications
2227 54.10.4.6 MDI connector specifications
2229 55. Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-T
55.1 Overview
55.1.1 Objectives
2230 55.1.2 Relationship of 10GBASE-T to other standards
55.1.3 Operation of 10GBASE-T
2232 55.1.3.1 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
2233 55.1.3.2 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
2234 55.1.4 Signaling
55.1.5 Interfaces
55.1.6 Conventions in this clause
2235 55.2 10GBASE-T service primitives and interfaces
55.2.1 Technology Dependent Interface
55.2.1.1 PMA_LINK.request
55.2.1.1.1 Semantics of the primitive
55.2.1.1.2 When generated
55.2.1.1.3 Effect of receipt
2236 55.2.1.2 PMA_LINK.indication
55.2.1.2.1 Semantics of the primitive
55.2.1.2.2 When generated
55.2.1.2.3 Effect of receipt
55.2.2 PMA service interface
2237 55.2.2.1 PMA_TXMODE.indication
55.2.2.1.1 Semantics of the primitive
2238 55.2.2.1.2 When generated
55.2.2.1.3 Effect of receipt
55.2.2.2 PMA_CONFIG.indication
55.2.2.2.1 Semantics of the primitive
55.2.2.2.2 When generated
55.2.2.2.3 Effect of receipt
55.2.2.3 PMA_UNITDATA.request
55.2.2.3.1 Semantics of the primitive
2239 55.2.2.3.2 When generated
55.2.2.3.3 Effect of receipt
55.2.2.4 PMA_UNITDATA.indication
55.2.2.4.1 Semantics of the primitive
55.2.2.4.2 When generated
55.2.2.4.3 Effect of receipt
55.2.2.5 PMA_SCRSTATUS.request
2240 55.2.2.5.1 Semantics of the primitive
55.2.2.5.2 When generated
55.2.2.5.3 Effect of receipt
55.2.2.6 PMA_PCSSTATUS.request
55.2.2.6.1 Semantics of the primitive
55.2.2.6.2 When generated
55.2.2.6.3 Effect of receipt
55.2.2.7 PMA_RXSTATUS.indication
55.2.2.7.1 Semantics of the primitive
2241 55.2.2.7.2 When generated
55.2.2.7.3 Effect of receipt
55.2.2.8 PMA_REMRXSTATUS.request
55.2.2.8.1 Semantics of the primitive
55.2.2.8.2 When generated
55.2.2.8.3 Effect of receipt
55.3 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
55.3.1 PCS service interface (XGMII)
55.3.2 PCS functions
2242 55.3.2.1 PCS Reset function
2243 55.3.2.2 PCS Transmit function
55.3.2.2.1 Use of blocks
2244 55.3.2.2.2 65B-LDPC transmission code
55.3.2.2.3 Notation conventions
55.3.2.2.4 Transmission order
55.3.2.2.5 Block structure
2247 55.3.2.2.6 Control codes
2248 55.3.2.2.7 Ordered sets
55.3.2.2.8 Valid and invalid blocks
2249 55.3.2.2.9 Idle (/I/)
2250 55.3.2.2.10 Start (/S/)
55.3.2.2.11 Terminate (/T/)
55.3.2.2.12 ordered_set (/O/)
55.3.2.2.13 Error (/E/)
55.3.2.2.14 Transmit process
55.3.2.2.15 PCS scrambler.
2251 55.3.2.2.16 CRC8
2252 55.3.2.2.17 LDPC encoder
55.3.2.2.18 DSQ128 bit mapping
2253 55.3.2.2.19 DSQ128 to 4D-PAM16
55.3.2.2.20 65B-LDPC framer
2254 55.3.2.3 PCS Receive function
55.3.2.3.1 Frame and block synchronization
55.3.2.3.2 PCS descrambler
55.3.2.3.3 CRC8 receive function
2255 55.3.3 Test-pattern generators
55.3.4 PMA training side-stream scrambler polynomials
2256 55.3.4.1 Generation of bits San, Sbn, Scn, Sdn
2257 55.3.4.2 Generation of 4D symbols TAn, TBn, TCn, TDn
55.3.4.3 PMA training mode descrambler polynomials
55.3.5 Detailed functions and state diagrams
55.3.5.1 State diagram conventions
55.3.5.2 State diagram parameters
55.3.5.2.1 Constants
2258 55.3.5.2.2 Variables
55.3.5.2.3 Timers
55.3.5.2.4 Functions
2260 55.3.5.2.5 Counters
55.3.5.3 Messages
55.3.5.4 State diagrams
55.3.6 PCS management
55.3.6.1 Status
2261 55.3.6.2 Counters
2264 55.3.6.3 Loopback
55.4 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer
55.4.1 PMA functional specifications
2265 55.4.2 PMA functions
55.4.2.1 PMA Reset function
55.4.2.2 PMA Transmit function
55.4.2.3 PMA transmit disable function
55.4.2.3.1 Global PMA transmit disable function
2266 55.4.2.3.2 PMA pair by pair transmit disable function
55.4.2.3.3 PMA MDIO function mapping
55.4.2.4 PMA Receive function
2267 55.4.2.5 PHY Control function
2268 55.4.2.5.1 Infofield notation
55.4.2.5.2 Start of Frame Delimiter
55.4.2.5.3 Current transmitter settings
2269 55.4.2.5.4 Next transmitter settings
55.4.2.5.5 Requested transmitter settings
55.4.2.5.6 Message Field
2270 55.4.2.5.7 SNR_margin
2271 55.4.2.5.8 Transition counter
55.4.2.5.9 Coefficient exchange handshake
55.4.2.5.10 Reserved Fields
55.4.2.5.11 Vendor specific field
55.4.2.5.12 Coefficient Field
55.4.2.5.13 CRC16
2272 55.4.2.5.14 Startup sequence
2274 55.4.2.6 Link Monitor function
2275 55.4.2.7 Clock Recovery function
55.4.3 MDI
55.4.3.1 MDI signals transmitted by the PHY
2276 55.4.3.2 Signals received at the MDI
55.4.4 Automatic MDI/MDI-X configuration
2277 55.4.5 State variables
55.4.5.1 State diagram variables
2279 55.4.5.2 Timers
2280 55.4.5.3 Functions
2281 55.4.6 State diagrams
55.4.6.1 PHY Control state diagram
2282 55.4.6.2 Transition counter state diagrams
2284 55.4.6.3 Link Monitor state diagram
55.5 PMA electrical specifications
55.5.1 Isolation requirement
2285 55.5.2 Test modes
2287 55.5.2.1 Test fixtures
2288 55.5.3 Transmitter electrical specifications
55.5.3.1 Maximum output droop
55.5.3.2 Transmitter linearity.
2289 55.5.3.3 Transmitter timing jitter
55.5.3.4 Transmitter power spectral density (PSD) and power level
2290 55.5.3.5 Transmit clock frequency
55.5.4 Receiver electrical specifications
55.5.4.1 Receiver differential input signals
2291 55.5.4.2 Receiver frequency tolerance
55.5.4.3 Common-mode noise rejection
55.5.4.4 Alien crosstalk noise rejection
2292 55.5.4.5 Short reach mode link test
55.5.4.5.1 Short reach test channels
55.6 Management interfaces
55.6.1 Support for Auto-Negotiation
2293 55.6.1.1 10GBASE-T use of registers during Auto-Negotiation
55.6.1.2 10GBASE-T Auto-Negotiation page use
2295 55.6.1.3 Sending next pages
55.6.2 MASTER-SLAVE configuration resolution
2297 55.7 Link segment characteristics
55.7.1 Cabling system characteristics
55.7.2 Link segment transmission parameters
2298 55.7.2.1 Insertion loss
55.7.2.2 Differential characteristic impedance
55.7.2.3 Return loss
2299 55.7.2.4 Coupling parameters between duplex channels comprising one link segment
55.7.2.4.1 Differential near-end crosstalk
55.7.2.4.2 Multiple disturber near-end crosstalk (MDNEXT) loss
2300 55.7.2.4.3 Multiple disturber power sum near-end crosstalk (PSNEXT) loss
55.7.2.4.4 Equal level far-end crosstalk (ELFEXT)
2301 55.7.2.4.5 Multiple disturber equal level far-end crosstalk (MDELFEXT)
55.7.2.4.6 Multiple disturber power sum equal level far-end crosstalk (PS ELFEXT)
2302 55.7.2.5 Maximum link delay
55.7.2.6 Link delay skew
55.7.3 Coupling parameters between link segments
55.7.3.1 Multiple disturber alien near-end crosstalk (MDANEXT) loss
55.7.3.1.1 Multiple disturber power sum alien near-end crosstalk (PSANEXT) loss
2304 55.7.3.1.2 PSANEXT loss to insertion loss ratio requirements
2305 55.7.3.2 Multiple disturber alien far-end crosstalk (MDAFEXT) loss
55.7.3.2.1 Multiple disturber power sum alien equal level far-end crosstalk (PSAELFEXT)
2307 55.7.3.2.2 PSAELFEXT to insertion loss ratio requirements
2308 55.7.3.3 Alien crosstalk margin computation
2312 55.7.4 Noise environment
2313 55.8 MDI specification
55.8.1 MDI connectors
2314 55.8.2 MDI electrical specifications
55.8.2.1 MDI return loss
2315 55.8.2.2 MDI impedance balance
2316 55.8.2.3 MDI fault tolerance
2317 55.9 Environmental specifications
55.9.1 General safety
55.9.2 Network safety
55.9.3 Installation and maintenance guidelines
55.9.4 Telephone voltages
2318 55.9.5 Electromagnetic compatibility
55.9.6 Temperature and humidity
55.10 PHY labeling
55.11 Delay constraints
2319 55.12 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 55—Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-T
55.12.1 Identification
55.12.1.1 Implementation identification
55.12.1.2 Protocol summary
55.12.2 Major capabilities/options
2320 55.12.3 Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS)
55.12.3.1 PCS Receive functions
2321 55.12.3.2 Other PCS functions
55.12.4 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA)
2322 55.12.5 Management interface
2324 55.12.6 PMA Electrical Specifications
2325 55.12.7 Characteristics of the link segment
55.12.8 MDI requirements
2326 55.12.9 General safety and environmental requirements
55.12.10 Timing requirements
2327 Annex 44A (informative) Diagram of Data Flow
44A.1 10GBASE-R bit ordering
44A.2 10GBASE-W serial bit ordering
44A.3 10GBASE-LX4 bit ordering
2333 44A.4 Loopback locations
2335 Annex 45A (informative) Clause 45 MDIO electrical interface
45A.1 MDIO driver
45A.2 Single Clause 45 electrical interface
2336 45A.3 Clause 45 electrical interface for STA with Clause 22 electrical interface to PHYs
45A.4 Clause 22 electrical interface for STA with Clause 45 electrical interface to MMDs
2339 Annex 48A (normative) Jitter test patterns
48A.1 High-frequency test pattern
48A.2 Low-frequency test pattern
48A.3 Mixed-frequency test pattern
2340 48A.4 Continuous random test pattern (CRPAT)
2341 48A.5 Continuous jitter test pattern (CJPAT)
2342 48A.5.1 Continuous jitter test pattern (CJPAT) 10 bit values
2347 Annex 48B (informative) Jitter test methods
48B.1 BER and jitter model
48B.1.1 Description of dual Dirac mathematical model
2349 48B.1.2 Random Jitter
48B.1.3 Addition of Deterministic Jitter
48B.1.4 Effects of jitter high-pass filtering and CJPAT on deterministic jitter
2350 48B.2 Jitter tolerance test methodologies
48B.2.1 Calibration of a signal source using the BERT scan technique
2351 48B.3 Jitter output test methodologies
48B.3.1 Time domain measurement—Scope and BERT scan
48B.3.1.1 Jitter high pass filtering (using Golden PLL)
2352 48B.3.1.2 Time domain scope measurement
48B.3.1.3 BERT Scan
48B.3.1.3.1 Approximate curve-fitting for BERT scan
2353 48B.3.2 Time Interval Analysis
48B.3.2.1 TIA with Golden PLL
2354 48B.3.2.1.1 Test method
2355 48B.3.2.2 TIA with pattern trigger
2356 48B.3.2.2.1 Test Method
48B.3.2.3 Approximate curve fitting for TIA bathtub curve
2357 Annex 50A (informative) Thresholds for Severely Errored Second calculations
50A.1 Section SES threshold
50A.2 Line SES threshold
50A.3 Path SES threshold
2358 50A.4 Definition of Path Block Error
50A.5 Definition of Far End Path Block Error
2359 Annex 55A (normative) LDPC details
55A.1 The generator matrix
55A.2 The sparse parity check matrix H
2360 Annex 55B (informative) Additional cabling design guidelines for 10GBASE-T
55B.1 Alien crosstalk considerations
2361 55B.1 1 Alien crosstalk mitigation
2362 55B.1 2 Alien crosstalk mitigation procedure
2363 802.3-2008_section5
SECTION FIVE
56. Introduction to Ethernet for subscriber access networks
56.1 Overview
56.1.1 Summary of P2P sublayers
2364 56.1.2 Summary of P2MP sublayers
56.1.2.1 Multipoint MAC Control Protocol (MPCP)
56.1.2.2 Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and media independent interfaces
2365 56.1.3 Physical Layer signaling systems
2367 56.1.4 Management
2368 56.1.5 Unidirectional transmission
56.2 State diagrams
56.3 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma
2369 57. Operations, Administration, and Maintenance (OAM)
57.1 Overview
57.1.1 Scope
57.1.2 Summary of objectives and major concepts
2370 57.1.3 Summary of non-objectives
57.1.4 Positioning of OAM within the IEEE 802.3 architecture
57.1.5 Compatibility considerations
57.1.5.1 Application
57.1.5.2 Interoperability between OAM capable DTEs
2371 57.1.5.3 MAC Control PAUSE
57.1.5.4 Interface to MAC Control client
57.1.5.5 Frame loss during OAM remote loopback
57.1.6 State diagram conventions
57.2 Functional specifications
57.2.1 Interlayer service interfaces
2372 57.2.2 Principles of operation
57.2.3 Instances of the MAC data service interface
57.2.4 Responsibilities of OAM client
2373 57.2.5 OAM client interactions
57.2.5.1 OAMPDU.request
57.2.5.1.1 Function
57.2.5.1.2 Semantics of the service primitive
57.2.5.1.3 When generated
57.2.5.1.4 Effect of receipt
57.2.5.2 OAMPDU.indication
57.2.5.2.1 Function
2374 57.2.5.2.2 Semantics of the service primitive
57.2.5.2.3 When generated
57.2.5.2.4 Effect of receipt
57.2.5.3 OAM_CTL.request
57.2.5.3.1 Function
57.2.5.3.2 Semantics of the service primitive
2375 57.2.5.3.3 When generated
57.2.5.3.4 Effect of receipt
57.2.5.4 OAM_CTL.indication
57.2.5.4.1 Function
57.2.5.4.2 Semantics of the service primitive
2376 57.2.5.4.3 When generated
57.2.5.4.4 Effect of receipt
57.2.6 Instances of the OAM internal service interface
57.2.7 Internal block diagram
2377 57.2.8 OAM internal interactions
57.2.8.1 OAMI.request
57.2.8.1.1 Function
57.2.8.1.2 Semantics of the service primitive
57.2.8.1.3 When generated
57.2.8.1.4 Effect of receipt
57.2.8.2 OAMI.indication
57.2.8.2.1 Function
2378 57.2.8.2.2 Semantics of the service primitive
57.2.8.2.3 When generated
57.2.8.2.4 Effect of receipt
57.2.9 Modes
2379 57.2.9.1 Active mode
57.2.9.2 Passive mode
57.2.10 OAM events
57.2.10.1 Critical link events
57.2.10.2 Link events
57.2.10.3 Local event procedure
2380 57.2.10.4 Remote event procedure
57.2.11 OAM remote loopback
57.2.11.1 Initiating OAM remote loopback
2381 57.2.11.2 During OAM remote loopback
57.2.11.3 Exiting OAM remote loopback
57.2.11.4 Loss of OAMPDUs during OAM remote loopback
2382 57.2.11.5 Loss of frames during OAM remote loopback
57.2.11.6 Timing considerations for OAM remote loopback
57.2.12 Unidirectional OAM operation
57.3 Detailed functions and state diagrams
2383 57.3.1 State diagram variables
57.3.1.1 Constants
57.3.1.2 Variables
2385 57.3.1.3 Messages
2386 57.3.1.4 Counters
57.3.1.5 Timers
2387 57.3.2 Control
57.3.2.1 OAM Discovery
2388 57.3.2.1.1 FAULT state
57.3.2.1.2 ACTIVE_SEND_LOCAL state
57.3.2.1.3 PASSIVE_WAIT state
57.3.2.1.4 SEND_LOCAL_REMOTE state
57.3.2.1.5 SEND_LOCAL_REMOTE_OK state
57.3.2.1.6 SEND_ANY state
57.3.2.1.7 Sending Discovery status to peer
2389 57.3.2.2 Transmit
57.3.2.2.1 RESET state
57.3.2.2.2 WAIT_FOR_TX state
2390 57.3.2.2.3 Expiration of pdu_timer
57.3.2.2.4 Valid request to send an OAMPDU
57.3.2.2.5 TX_OAMPDU state
57.3.2.2.6 Transmit rules
57.3.2.3 Receive rules
2391 57.3.3 Multiplexer
57.3.3.1 WAIT_FOR_TX state
57.3.3.1.1 Valid request to send an OAMPDU
57.3.3.1.2 Valid request to forward or loopback frame
2392 57.3.3.2 TX_FRAME state
57.3.4 Parser
57.3.4.1 Reception of OAMPDU
2393 57.3.4.2 Reception of non-OAMPDUs
57.3.4.2.1 Reception of non-OAMPDU in FWD mode
57.3.4.2.2 Reception of non-OAMPDU in LB mode
57.3.4.2.3 Reception of non-OAMPDU in DISCARD mode
57.4 OAMPDUs
57.4.1 Ordering and representation of octets
2394 57.4.2 Structure
57.4.2.1 Flags field
2395 57.4.2.2 Code field
57.4.3 OAMPDU descriptions
2396 57.4.3.1 Information OAMPDU
57.4.3.2 Event Notification OAMPDU
2397 57.4.3.3 Variable Request OAMPDU
2398 57.4.3.4 Variable Response OAMPDU
57.4.3.5 Loopback Control OAMPDU
2399 57.4.3.6 Organization Specific OAMPDU
57.5 OAM TLVs
57.5.1 Parsing
2400 57.5.2 Information TLVs
57.5.2.1 Local Information TLV
2403 57.5.2.2 Remote Information TLV
57.5.2.3 Organization Specific Information TLV
57.5.3 Link Event TLVs
2404 57.5.3.1 Errored Symbol Period Event TLV
2405 57.5.3.2 Errored Frame Event TLV
57.5.3.3 Errored Frame Period Event TLV
2406 57.5.3.4 Errored Frame Seconds Summary Event TLV
2407 57.5.3.5 Organization Specific Event TLVs
2408 57.6 Variables
57.6.1 Variable Descriptors
57.6.2 Variable Containers
2409 57.6.2.1 Format of Variable Containers when returning attributes
57.6.2.2 Format of Variable Containers when returning packages and objects
2410 57.6.3 Parsing
2411 57.6.4 Variable Branch/Leaf examples
57.6.5 Variable Indications
2412 57.7 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 57, Operations, Administration, and Maintenance (OAM)
57.7.1 Introduction
57.7.2 Identification
57.7.2.1 Implementation identification
2413 57.7.2.2 Protocol summary
2414 57.7.2.3 Major capabilities/options
57.7.3 PICS proforma tables for Operation, Administration, and Maintenance (OAM)
57.7.3.1 Functional specifications
2415 57.7.3.2 Event Notification Generation and Reception
2416 57.7.3.3 OAMPDUs
2417 57.7.3.4 Local Information TLVs
57.7.3.5 Remote Information TLVs
2418 57.7.3.6 Organization Specific Information TLVs
57.7.4 Link Event TLVs
2419 57.7.5 Variables Descriptors and Containers
2421 58. Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and medium, type 100BASE-LX10 (Long Wavelength) and 100BASE-BX10 (BiDirectional Long Wavelength)
58.1 Overview
58.1.1 Goals and objectives
2422 58.1.2 Positioning of this PMD set within the IEEE 802.3 architecture
58.1.3 Terminology and conventions
58.1.4 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer service interface
2423 58.1.4.1 Delay constraints
58.1.4.2 PMD_UNITDATA.request
58.1.4.3 PMD_UNITDATA.indication
58.1.4.4 PMD_SIGNAL.indication
58.2 PMD functional specifications
2424 58.2.1 PMD block diagram
58.2.2 PMD transmit function
58.2.3 PMD receive function
2425 58.2.4 100BASE-LX10 and 100BASE-BX10 signal detect function
58.3 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 100BASE-LX10
58.3.1 Transmitter optical specifications
2426 58.3.2 Receiver optical specifications
2427 58.4 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 100BASE-BX10
58.4.1 Transmit optical specifications
2428 58.4.2 Receiver optical specifications
2429 58.5 Illustrative 100BASE-LX10 and 100BASE-BX10 channels and penalties (informative)
2430 58.6 Jitter at TP1 and TP4 for 100BASE-LX10 and 100BASE-BX10 (informative)
58.7 Optical measurement requirements
2431 58.7.1 Test patterns
58.7.1.1 100BASE-X optical frame-based test pattern
2433 58.7.2 Wavelength and spectral width measurements
58.7.3 Optical power measurements
58.7.4 Extinction ratio measurements
2434 58.7.5 Optical modulation amplitude (OMA) measurements (informative)
58.7.6 OMA relationship to extinction ratio and power measurements (informative)
2435 58.7.7 Relative intensity noise optical modulation amplitude (RINxOMA) measuring procedure
58.7.7.1 General test description
2436 58.7.7.2 Component descriptions
58.7.7.3 Test procedure
2437 58.7.8 Transmitter optical waveform (transmit eye)
2438 58.7.9 Transmitter and dispersion penalty (TDP) measurement
2439 58.7.9.1 Reference transmitter requirements
58.7.9.2 Channel requirements
2440 58.7.9.3 Reference receiver requirements
2441 58.7.9.4 Test procedure
58.7.9.5 Approximate measures of TDP (informative)
2442 58.7.10 Receiver sensitivity measurements
58.7.11 Stressed receiver conformance test
2443 58.7.11.1 Stressed receiver conformance test block diagram
2445 58.7.11.2 Stressed receiver conformance test signal characteristics and calibration
2447 58.7.11.3 Stressed receiver conformance test procedure
58.7.11.4 Sinusoidal jitter for receiver conformance test
2448 58.7.12 Jitter measurements (informative)
2450 58.8 Environmental, safety, and labeling
58.8.1 General safety
58.8.2 Laser safety
58.8.3 Installation
58.8.4 Environment
58.8.5 PMD labeling requirements
2451 58.9 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling
58.9.1 Fiber optic cabling model
58.9.2 Optical fiber and cable
2452 58.9.3 Optical fiber connection
58.9.4 Medium Dependent Interface (MDI)
2453 58.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 58, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and medium, type 100BASE-LX10 (Long Wavelength) and 100BASE-BX10 (BiDirectional Long Wavelength)
58.10.1 Introduction
58.10.2 Identification
58.10.2.1 Implementation identification
58.10.2.2 Protocol summary
2454 58.10.2.3 Major capabilities/options
58.10.3 PICS proforma tables for Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and medium, type 100BASE-LX10 and 100BASE-BX10
58.10.3.1 PMD functional specifications
2455 58.10.3.2 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 100BASE-LX10
58.10.3.3 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 100BASE-BX10-D
58.10.3.4 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 100BASE-BX10-U
2456 58.10.3.5 Optical measurement requirements
58.10.3.6 Environmental specifications
58.10.3.7 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling and MDI
2457 59. Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and medium, type 1000BASE-LX10 (Long Wavelength) and 1000BASE-BX10 (BiDirectional Long Wavelength)
59.1 Overview
2458 59.1.1 Goals and objectives
59.1.2 Positioning of 1000BASE-LX10 and 1000BASE-BX10 PMDs within the IEEE 802.3 architecture
59.1.3 Terminology and conventions
2459 59.1.4 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer service interface
59.1.5 Delay constraints
59.1.5.1 PMD_UNITDATA.request
59.1.5.2 PMD_UNITDATA.indication
59.1.5.3 PMD_SIGNAL.indication
2460 59.2 PMD functional specifications
59.2.1 PMD block diagram
59.2.2 PMD transmit function
59.2.3 PMD receive function
2461 59.2.4 PMD signal detect function
59.3 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-LX10
59.3.1 Transmitter optical specifications
2463 59.3.2 Receiver optical specifications
2464 59.4 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-BX10-D and 1000BASE-BX10-U
59.4.1 Transmit optical specifications
2465 59.4.2 Receiver optical specifications
2466 59.5 Illustrative 1000BASE-LX10 and 1000BASE-BX10 channels and penalties (informative)
59.6 Jitter specifications
2467 59.7 Optical measurement requirements
59.7.1 Test patterns
2470 59.7.2 Wavelength and spectral width measurements
2471 59.7.3 Optical power measurements
59.7.4 Extinction ratio measurements
59.7.5 OMA measurements (informative)
59.7.6 OMA relationship to extinction ratio and power measurements (informative)
59.7.7 Relative intensity noise optical modulation amplitude (RIN12OMA)
59.7.8 Transmitter optical waveform (transmit eye)
2472 59.7.9 Transmit rise/fall characteristics
59.7.10 Transmitter and dispersion penalty (TDP)
59.7.11 Receive sensitivity measurements
2473 59.7.12 Total jitter measurements (informative)
59.7.13 Deterministic or high probability jitter measurement (informative)
59.7.14 Stressed receiver conformance test
2474 59.7.15 Measurement of the receiver 3 dB electrical upper cutoff frequency
59.8 Environmental, safety, and labeling specifications
59.8.1 General safety
2475 59.8.2 Laser safety
59.8.3 Installation
59.8.4 Environment
59.8.5 PMD labeling requirements
59.9 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling
2476 59.9.1 Fiber optic cabling model
59.9.2 Optical fiber and cable
2477 59.9.3 Optical fiber connection
59.9.4 Medium Dependent Interface (MDI)
2478 59.9.5 Single-mode fiber offset-launch mode-conditioning patch cord for MMF operation of 1000BASE-LX10
2480 59.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 59, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and medium, type 1000BASE-LX10 (Long Wavelength) and 1000BASE-BX10 (BiDirectional Long Wavelength)
59.10.1 Introduction
59.10.2 Identification
59.10.2.1 Implementation identification
59.10.2.2 Protocol summary
2481 59.10.3 Major capabilities/options
59.10.3.1 PMD functional specifications
2482 59.10.3.2 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-LX10
59.10.3.3 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-BX10-D
59.10.3.4 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-BX10-U
2483 59.10.3.5 Optical Measurement requirements
59.10.3.6 Environmental, safety, and labeling specifications
2484 59.10.3.7 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling
59.10.3.8 Offset-launch mode-conditioning patch cord
2485 60. Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and medium, type 1000BASE-PX10 and 1000BASE-PX20 (long wavelength passive optical networks)
60.1 Overview
2486 60.1.1 Goals and objectives
60.1.2 Positioning of this PMD set within the IEEE 802.3 architecture
60.1.3 Terminology and conventions
2487 60.1.4 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer service interface
60.1.5 Delay constraints
60.1.5.1 PMD_UNITDATA.request
60.1.5.2 PMD_UNITDATA.indication
60.1.5.3 PMD_SIGNAL.request
60.1.5.4 PMD_SIGNAL.indication
2488 60.2 PMD functional specifications
60.2.1 PMD block diagram
2489 60.2.2 PMD transmit function
60.2.3 PMD receive function
60.2.4 PMD signal detect function
60.2.4.1 ONU PMD signal detect (downstream)
60.2.4.2 OLT PMD signal detect (upstream)
60.2.4.3 1000BASE-PX Signal detect functions
2490 60.2.5 PMD transmit enable function for ONU
60.3 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-PX10-D and 1000BASE-PX10-U
60.3.1 Transmitter optical specifications
2492 60.3.2 Receiver optical specifications
60.4 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-PX20-D and 1000BASE-PX20-U
2493 60.4.1 Transmit optical specifications
2494 60.4.2 Receiver optical specifications
2495 60.5 Illustrative 1000BASE-PX10 and 1000BASE-PX20 channels and penalties (informative)
2496 60.6 Jitter at TP1-4 for 1000BASE-PX10 and 1000BASE-PX20 (informative)
2498 60.7 Optical measurement requirements
60.7.1 Frame-based test patterns
60.7.2 Wavelength and spectral width measurements
60.7.3 Optical power measurements
2499 60.7.4 Extinction ratio measurements
60.7.5 OMA measurements (informative)
60.7.6 OMA relationship to extinction ratio and power measurements (informative)
60.7.7 Relative intensity noise optical modulation amplitude (RIN15OMA)
60.7.8 Transmitter optical waveform (transmit eye)
2500 60.7.9 Transmitter and dispersion penalty (TDP)
60.7.10 Receive sensitivity measurement
60.7.11 Stressed receive conformance test
60.7.12 Jitter measurements (informative)
60.7.13 Other measurements
60.7.13.1 Laser On/Off timing measurement
60.7.13.1.1 Definitions
2501 60.7.13.1.2 Test specification
2502 60.7.13.2 Receiver settling timing measurement (informative)
60.7.13.2.1 Definitions
2503 60.7.13.2.2 Test specification
2504 60.8 Environmental, safety, and labeling
60.8.1 General safety
60.8.2 Laser safety
60.8.3 Installation
60.8.4 Environment
60.8.5 PMD labeling requirements
2505 60.9 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling
60.9.1 Fiber optic cabling model
60.9.2 Optical fiber and cable
2506 60.9.3 Optical fiber connection
60.9.4 Medium Dependent Interface (MDI)
2507 60.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 60, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and medium, type 1000BASE-PX10 and 1000BASE-PX20 (long wavelength passive optical networks)
60.10.1 Introduction
60.10.2 Identification
60.10.2.1 Implementation identification
60.10.2.2 Protocol Summary
2508 60.10.3 Major capabilities/options
60.10.4 PICS proforma tables for Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and medium, type 1000BASE-PX10 and 1000BASE-PX20 (long wavelength passive optical networks)
60.10.4.1 PMD functional specifications
2509 60.10.4.2 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-PX10-D
60.10.4.3 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-PX10-U
60.10.4.4 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-PX20-D
2510 60.10.4.5 PMD to MDI optical specifications for 1000BASE-PX20-U
60.10.4.6 Optical measurement requirements
2511 60.10.4.7 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling and MDI
60.10.4.8 Environmental specifications
2513 61. Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Transmission Convergence (TC) sublayer, and common specifications, type 10PASS-TS and type 2BASE-TL
61.1 Overview
61.1.1 Scope
2514 61.1.2 Objectives
61.1.3 Relation of 2BASE-TL and 10PASS-TS to other standards
2515 61.1.4 Summary
61.1.4.1 Summary of Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) specification
2516 61.1.4.1.1 Implementation of Media Independent Interface
61.1.4.1.2 Summary of MAC-PHY Rate Matching specification
61.1.4.1.3 Summary of PME Aggregation specification
2517 61.1.4.1.4 Overview of management
61.1.4.2 Summary of Transmission Convergence (TC) specification
61.1.4.3 Summary of handshaking and PHY control specification
61.1.5 Application of 2BASE-TL, 10PASS-TS
61.1.5.1 Compatibility considerations
61.1.5.2 Incorporating the 2BASE-TL, 10PASS-TS PHY into a DTE
61.1.5.3 Application and examples of PME Aggregation
2518 61.1.5.3.1 Addressing PCS and PME instances
61.1.5.3.2 Indicating PME aggregation capability
2520 61.1.5.3.3 Setting PME aggregation connection
2521 61.1.5.4 Support for handshaking
2522 61.2 PCS functional specifications
61.2.1 MAC-PHY Rate Matching functional specifications
61.2.1.1 MAC-PHY Rate Matching functions
61.2.1.2 MAC-PHY Rate Matching functional interfaces
61.2.1.2.1 MAC-PHY Rate Matching – MII signals
61.2.1.2.2 MAC-PHY Rate Matching–Management entity signals
61.2.1.3 MAC-PHY Rate Matching state diagrams
61.2.1.3.1 MAC-PHY Rate Matching state diagram constants
61.2.1.3.2 MAC-PHY Rate Matching state diagram variables
2523 61.2.1.3.3 MAC-PHY Rate Matching state diagram timers
61.2.1.3.4 MAC-PHY Rate Matching state diagram functions
61.2.1.3.5 MAC-PHY Rate Matching state diagrams
2525 61.2.2 PME Aggregation functional specifications
2526 61.2.2.1 PAF Enable and Bypass
61.2.2.2 PME Aggregation functions
2527 61.2.2.3 PME Aggregation Transmit function
61.2.2.4 PME Aggregation Receive function
61.2.2.4.1 Expected sequence number
61.2.2.4.2 PME Aggregation Receive function state diagram variables
2528 61.2.2.4.3 PME Aggregation Receive function state diagram
61.2.2.4.4 PME Aggregation Receive function state diagram description
2529 61.2.2.5 PME Aggregation restrictions
2530 61.2.2.6 PME Aggregation transmit function restrictions
2531 61.2.2.7 Error-detecting rules
61.2.2.7.1 Errors during fragment reception
2532 61.2.2.7.2 Errors in fragment sequencing
61.2.2.7.3 Errors in packet reassembly
61.2.2.8 PME aggregation functional interfaces
61.2.2.8.1 PME aggregation–g-interface signals
61.2.2.8.2 PME aggregation–management entity signals
2533 61.2.2.8.3 PME aggregation register functions
2534 61.2.2.8.4 PME aggregation discovery register functions
61.2.3 PCS sublayer: Management entity signals
2536 61.3 TC sublayer functional specifications
2537 61.3.1 The g-interface
2538 61.3.2 The a(b)-interface
61.3.2.1 a(b) data flow: reference G.993.1 section 7.1.1
61.3.2.2 a(b) synchronization flow
2539 61.3.2.3 a(b) OAM flow
61.3.3 TC functions
61.3.3.1 TC encapsulation and coding
2542 61.3.3.2 Sync insertion and transmit control
2543 61.3.3.3 TC-CRC functions
2544 61.3.3.4 Bit ordering
2546 61.3.3.5 Sync detection
2547 61.3.3.5.1 State diagram variables
61.3.3.5.2 State diagram
61.3.3.6 Receive control
2548 61.3.3.7 State diagrams for 64/65-octet encapsulation
61.3.3.7.1 Transmit state diagram
2551 61.3.3.7.2 Receive state diagram
2554 61.3.3.8 TC sublayer management entity signals
61.4 Handshaking and PHY control specification for type 2BASE-TL and 10PASS-TS
61.4.1 Overview
61.4.2 Replacement of 1, “Scope”
61.4.2.1 Scope
2555 61.4.2.2 Purpose
61.4.3 Changes to 6.1, “Description of signals”
61.4.4 Changes to 9.4, “Standard information field (S)”
2556 61.4.5 Changes to 9.5, “Non-standard information field (NS)”
61.4.6 Applicability of Annex A–B and Appendix I–VI
61.4.7 PME Aggregation – remote access of PME Aggregation registers
61.4.7.1 Remote_discovery_register
2558 61.4.7.2 PME_Aggregate_register
2559 61.4.7.3 Timing and preferred transactions
61.5 Link segment characteristics
2560 61.6 MDI specification
61.7 System considerations
61.8 Environmental specifications
61.9 PHY labeling
2561 61.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 61, Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Transmission Convergence (TC) sublayer, and common specifications type 10PASS-TS, 2BASE-TL
61.10.1 Introduction
61.10.2 Identification
61.10.2.1 Implementation identification
61.10.2.2 Protocol summary
2562 61.10.3 Major capabilities/options
61.10.4 PICS proforma tables for the Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS), Transmission Convergence (TC) sublayer, and common specifications type 10PASS-TS, 2BASE-TL
61.10.4.1 MAC-PHY Rate Matching
2563 61.10.4.2 64/65-octet Encapsulation
2564 61.10.4.3 PME Aggregation
2569 61.10.4.4 Handshaking
2571 62. Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) and Physical Medium Dependent (PMD), type 10PASS-TS
62.1 Overview
62.1.1 Scope
62.1.2 Objectives
62.1.3 Relation of 10PASS-TS to other standards
62.1.4 Summary of Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) specification
62.1.4.1 a(b)-interface
62.1.4.2 I-interface
62.1.4.2.1 I Data Flow
2572 62.1.4.2.2 I Synchronization Flow
62.2 PMA functional specifications
62.2.1 PMA functional diagram
62.2.2 PMA functional specifications
2573 62.2.3 General exceptions
2574 62.2.4 Specific requirements and exceptions
62.2.4.1 Replacement of 9.3.1, “PMS-TC functional diagram”
62.2.4.2 Changes to 9.3.3, “Forward error correction”
62.2.4.3 Changes to 9.3.5, “Framing”
62.3 PMD functional specifications
62.3.1 PMD Overview
2575 62.3.2 PMD functional specifications
62.3.3 General exceptions
2576 62.3.4 Specific requirements and exceptions
62.3.4.1 Replacement of 8.2.1, “Multi-carrier Modulation”
2577 62.3.4.2 Changes to 8.2.2, “Cyclic extension”
62.3.4.3 Changes to 8.2.3, “Synchronization”
62.3.4.4 Replacement of 8.2.4, “Power back-off in the upstream direction”
2578 62.3.4.5 Changes to 8.2.5, “Constellation encoder”
62.3.4.6 Changes to 8.2.8, “U-interface characteristics”
2579 62.3.4.7 Changes to section 10, “Operations and maintenance”
2580 62.3.4.8 Changes to 11.1, “VDSL Link State and Timing Diagram”
2581 62.3.4.9 Changes to section 18 (Annex 4), “Handshake procedure for VDSL”
62.3.4.9.1 Replacement of 18.1, “Introduction”
62.3.4.9.2 Replacement of 18.2, “Description of signals”
62.3.4.9.3 Replacement of 18.3, “Message coding format”
62.3.4.9.4 Replacement of 18.4.1, “Handshake – 10PASS-TS-O”
2583 62.3.4.9.5 Replacement of 18.4.2, “Handshake – 10PASS-TS-R”
2584 62.3.5 Transmission medium interface characteristics
2585 62.3.5.1 Transmit signal characteristics
62.3.5.1.1 Wide-band power
2586 62.3.5.1.2 Power spectral density (PSD)
62.3.5.1.3 Egress control
62.3.5.2 Termination impedance
62.3.5.3 Return loss
2587 62.3.5.4 Output signal balance
2588 62.4 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 62, Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) and Physical Medium Dependent (PMD), type 10PASS-TS
62.4.1 Introduction
62.4.2 Identification
62.4.2.1 Implementation identification
62.4.2.2 Protocol summary
2589 62.4.3 Major capabilities/options
62.4.4 PICS proforma tables for the Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) and Physical Medium Dependent (PMD), type 10PASS-TS
62.4.4.1 MCM-VDSL based PMA
2590 62.4.4.2 MCM-VDSL based PMD
2593 63. Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) and Physical Medium Dependent (PMD), type 2BASE-TL
63.1 2BASE-TL Overview
63.1.1 Scope
63.1.2 Objectives
63.1.3 Relation of 2BASE-TL to other standards
63.1.4 Summary of Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) specification
2594 63.1.4.1 a(b)-interface
63.1.4.2 The I-interface
63.1.4.2.1 The I Data Flow
2595 63.1.4.2.2 I Synchronization Flow
63.1.4.3 Operation Channel (OC)
63.1.5 Summary of Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) specification
2596 63.2 2BASE-TL PMA functional specifications
63.2.1 General exceptions
63.2.2 Specific requirements and exceptions
2597 63.2.2.1 Changes to 7.1, “Data Mode Operation”
63.2.2.2 Changes to Section 9, “Management”
63.2.2.3 Relation between the 2BASE-TL registers and the SHDSL management functions
2598 63.3 2BASE-TL PMD functional specifications
63.3.1 General exceptions
2599 63.3.2 Specific requirements and exceptions
63.3.2.1 Replacement of section 5, “Transport Capacity”
2600 63.3.2.2 Changes to section 6, “PMD Layer Functional Characteristics”
2601 63.3.2.3 Changes to section 10, “Clock Architecture”
63.3.2.4 Changes to Annex A, “Regional Requirements—Region 1”
63.3.2.4.1 General Changes
63.3.2.4.2 Additional requirement: wetting current
2602 63.3.2.5 Changes to Annex B, “Regional Requirements—Region 2”
63.3.2.5.1 General changes
63.3.2.5.2 Additional requirement: wetting current
63.3.2.6 Changes to Annex C, “Regional Requirements – Region 3”
2603 63.4 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 63, Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) and Physical Medium Dependent (PMD), type 2BASE-TL
63.4.1 Introduction
63.4.2 Identification
63.4.2.1 Implementation identification
63.4.2.2 Protocol summary
2604 63.4.3 Major capabilities/options
63.4.4 PICS proforma tables for the Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) and Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayers, type 2BASE-TL
63.4.4.1 SHDSL based PMA
2605 63.4.4.2 SHDSL based PMD
2607 64. Multipoint MAC Control
64.1 Overview
2608 64.1.1 Goals and objectives
64.1.2 Position of Multipoint MAC Control within the IEEE 802.3 hierarchy
2610 64.1.3 Functional block diagram
2611 64.1.4 Service interfaces
64.1.5 State diagram conventions
64.2 Multipoint MAC Control operation
2612 64.2.1 Principles of Multipoint MAC Control
2613 64.2.1.1 Ranging and Timing Process
2614 64.2.2 Multipoint transmission control, Control Parser, and Control Multiplexer
2617 64.2.2.1 Constants
64.2.2.2 Counters
2618 64.2.2.3 Variables
2619 64.2.2.4 Functions
2620 64.2.2.5 Timers
64.2.2.6 Messages
64.2.2.7 State Diagrams
2626 64.3 Multipoint Control Protocol (MPCP)
64.3.1 Principles of Multipoint Control Protocol
64.3.2 Compatibility considerations
64.3.2.1 PAUSE operation
2627 64.3.2.2 Optional Shared LAN Emulation
64.3.2.3 Multicast and single copy broadcast support
64.3.2.4 Delay requirements
64.3.3 Discovery Processing
2631 64.3.3.1 Constants
64.3.3.2 Variables
2632 64.3.3.3 Functions
64.3.3.4 Timers
64.3.3.5 Messages
2635 64.3.3.6 State Diagram
2640 64.3.4 Report Processing
64.3.4.1 Constants
2641 64.3.4.2 Variables
64.3.4.3 Functions
64.3.4.4 Timers
64.3.4.5 Messages
2642 64.3.4.6 State Diagram
2644 64.3.5 Gate Processing
64.3.5.1 Constants
2645 64.3.5.2 Variables
2646 64.3.5.3 Functions
2647 64.3.5.4 Timers
64.3.5.5 Messages
2649 64.3.5.6 State Diagrams
2652 64.3.6 MPCPDU structure and encoding
2653 64.3.6.1 GATE description
2655 64.3.6.2 REPORT description
2656 64.3.6.3 .REGISTER_REQ description
2658 64.3.6.4 REGISTER description
2659 64.3.6.5 REGISTER_ACK description
2661 64.4 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 64, Multipoint MAC Control
64.4.1 Introduction
64.4.2 Identification
64.4.2.1 Implementation identification
64.4.2.2 Protocol summary
2662 64.4.3 Major capabilities/options
64.4.4 PICS proforma tables for Multipoint MAC Control
64.4.4.1 Compatibility Considerations
64.4.4.2 Multipoint MAC Control
2663 64.4.4.3 State diagrams
2664 64.4.4.4 MPCP
2665 65. Extensions of the Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) / Physical Media Attachment (PMA) for 1000BASE-X for multipoint links and forward error correction
65.1 Extensions of the Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) for point-to-point emulation
65.1.1 Overview
65.1.2 Principle of operation
2666 65.1.3 Functional specifications
65.1.3.1 Variables
65.1.3.2 Transmit
2667 65.1.3.2.1 SLD
65.1.3.2.2 LLID
65.1.3.2.3 CRC-8
65.1.3.3 Receive function
2668 65.1.3.3.1 SLD
65.1.3.3.2 LLID
2669 65.1.3.3.3 CRC-8
65.2 Extensions of the physical coding sublayer for data detection and forward error correction
65.2.1 Overview
2670 65.2.2 Burst-mode operation
65.2.2.1 Principle of operation
2672 65.2.2.2 Detailed functions and state diagrams
65.2.2.2.1 Variables
2673 65.2.2.2.2 Functions
65.2.2.2.3 Messages
65.2.2.2.4 Counters
2674 65.2.2.3 State Diagrams
65.2.3 Forward error correction
2675 65.2.3.1 FEC code
65.2.3.2 FEC frame format
65.2.3.2.1 Placing parity octets
65.2.3.2.2 Shortened last block
65.2.3.2.3 Special frame markers
2676 65.2.3.3 FEC sublayer operation
65.2.3.3.1 Principles of operation
2677 65.2.3.3.2 Functional block diagram
65.2.3.3.3 Transmission
2678 65.2.3.3.4 Reception
2679 65.2.3.4 Detailed functions and state diagrams
65.2.3.4.1 State variables
65.2.3.4.2 Notation conventions
65.2.3.4.3 Constants
2680 65.2.3.4.4 Variables
2682 65.2.3.4.5 Functions
2683 65.2.3.4.6 Counters
65.2.3.4.7 Messages
65.2.3.5 State diagrams
65.2.3.5.1 Transmit state diagram
2685 65.2.3.5.2 Receive synchronization state diagram
2686 65.2.3.5.3 Receive state diagram
2687 65.2.3.6 Error monitoring capability
65.2.3.6.1 buffer_head_coding_violation_counter
65.2.3.6.2 FEC_corrected_blocks_counter
65.2.3.6.3 FEC_uncorrected_Blocks_counter
2688 65.3 Extensions to PMA for 1000BASE-PX
65.3.1 Extensions for 1000BASE-PX-U
65.3.1.1 Physical Medium Attachment (PMA) sublayer interfaces
65.3.1.2 Loop-timing specifications for ONUs
65.3.2 Extensions for 1000BASE-PX-D
65.3.2.1 CDR lock timing measurement
65.3.2.1.1 Definitions
65.3.2.1.2 Test specification
2689 65.3.3 Delay variation requirements
2690 65.4 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 65, Extensions of the Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) / Physical Media Attachment (PMA) for 1000BASE-X for multipoint links and forward erro…
65.4.1 Introduction
65.4.2 Identification
65.4.2.1 Implementation identification
65.4.2.2 Protocol summary
2691 65.4.3 Major capabilities/options
65.4.4 PICS proforma tables for Extensions of Reconciliation Sublayer (RS) and Physical Coding Sublayer (PCS) / Physical Media Attachment (PMA) for 1000BASE-X for multipoint links and forward error correction
65.4.4.1 Operating modes of OLT MACs
65.4.4.2 ONU and OLT variables
2692 65.4.4.3 Preamble mapping and replacement
65.4.4.4 Data detection
65.4.4.5 FEC requirements
2693 65.4.4.6 FEC State diagrams
65.4.4.7 PMA
65.4.4.8 OLT Receiver
65.4.4.9 Delay variation
2695 66. Extensions of the 10 Gb/s Reconciliation Sublayer (RS), 100BASE-X PHY, and 1000BASE-X PHY for unidirectional transport
66.1 Modifications to the physical coding sublayer (PCS) and physical medium attachment (PMA) sublayer, type 100BASE-X
66.1.1 Overview
66.1.2 Functional specifications
66.1.2.1 Variables
66.1.2.2 Transmit state diagram
2696 66.1.2.3 Far-end fault generate
2697 66.2 Modifications to the physical coding sublayer (PCS) and physical medium attachment (PMA) sublayer, type 1000BASE-X
66.2.1 Overview
66.2.2 Functional specifications
2698 66.2.2.1 Variables
66.2.2.2 Transmit
66.2.2.3 Transmit state diagram
66.3 Modifications to the reconciliation sublayer (RS) for 10 Gb/s operation
66.3.1 Overview
2699 66.3.2 Functional specifications
66.3.2.1 Link fault signaling
66.3.2.2 Variables
66.3.2.3 State Diagram
2700 66.4 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 66, Extensions of the 10 Gb/s Reconciliation Sublayer (RS), 100BASE-X PHY, and 1000BASE-X PHY for unidirectional transport
66.4.1 Introduction
66.4.2 Identification
66.4.2.1 Implementation identification
66.4.2.2 Protocol summary
2701 66.4.3 Major capabilities/options
66.4.4 PICS proforma tables for Extensions of the 10 Gb/s Reconciliation Sublayer (RS), 100BASE-X PHY, and 1000BASE-X PHY for unidirectional transport
66.4.4.1 Maintaining compatibility with IEEE 802.1 protocols
66.4.4.2 Extensions of the 100BASE-X PHY
66.4.4.3 Extensions of the 1000BASE-X PHY
2702 66.4.4.4 Extensions of the 10 Gb/s RS
2703 67. System considerations for Ethernet subscriber access networks
67.1 Overview
2704 67.2 Discussion and examples of EFM P2MP topologies
67.2.1 Trade off between link span and split ratio
67.2.2 Single splitter topology
67.2.3 Tree-and-branch topology
2705 67.2.4 Interoperability between certain 1000BASE-PX10 and 1000BASE-PX20
67.3 Hybrid media topologies
67.4 Topology limitations
67.5 Deployment restrictions for subscriber access copper
2706 67.6 Operations, Administration, and Maintenance
67.6.1 Unidirectional links
67.6.2 Active and Passive modes
67.6.3 Link status signaling in P2MP networks
2707 68. Physical medium dependent (PMD) sublayer type 10GBASE-LRM
68.1 Overview
68.1.1 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer service interface
68.2 Delay constraints
2708 68.3 PMD MDIO function mapping
68.4 PMD functional specifications
68.4.1 PMD block diagram
68.4.2 PMD transmit function
2709 68.4.3 PMD receive function
68.4.4 PMD signal detect function
68.4.5 PMD_reset function
68.4.6 PMD_fault function
2710 68.4.7 PMD_global_transmit_disable function
68.4.8 PMD_transmit_fault function
68.4.9 PMD_receive_fault function
68.5 PMD to MDI optical specifications
2711 68.5.1 Transmitter optical specifications
2712 68.5.2 Characteristics of signal within, and at the receiving end of, a compliant 10GBASE- LRM channel (informative)
2713 68.5.3 Receiver optical specifications
2714 68.5.3.1 Dynamic response
68.6 Definitions of optical parameters and measurement methods
68.6.1 Test patterns and related subclauses for optical parameters
2715 68.6.2 Optical modulation amplitude (OMA)
68.6.3 Extinction ratio measurement
68.6.4 Relationship between OMA, extinction ratio and average power (informative)
2716 68.6.5 Transmitter optical waveform—transmitter eye mask
2717 68.6.5.1 Transmitter eye mask acceptable hit count examples (informative)
2718 68.6.6 Transmitter waveform and dispersion penalty (TWDP)
68.6.6.1 TWDP measurement procedure
2719 68.6.6.2 TWDP signal processing algorithm,
2722 68.6.7 Transmitter signal to noise ratio
68.6.8 Transmitter uncorrelated jitter
2723 68.6.9 Comprehensive stressed receiver sensitivity and overload
2724 68.6.9.1 Comprehensive stressed receiver sensitivity and overload test block diagram
68.6.9.2 Comprehensive stressed receiver test signal characteristics
2725 68.6.9.3 Comprehensive stressed receiver test signal calibration
2726 68.6.9.4 Comprehensive stressed receiver test procedure
68.6.10 Simple stressed receiver sensitivity and overload (informative)
2729 68.6.11 Receiver jitter tolerance
2730 68.7 Safety, installation, environment, and labeling
68.7.1 Safety
68.7.2 Installation
68.7.3 Environment
68.7.4 PMD labeling
68.8 Fiber optic cabling model
2731 68.9 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling (channel)
68.9.1 Optical fiber and cable
68.9.2 Optical fiber connections
68.9.2.1 Connection insertion loss
2732 68.9.2.2 Maximum discrete reflectance
68.9.3 Single-mode fiber offset-launch mode-conditioning patch cord
2733 68.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 68, Physical medium dependent (PMD) sublayer type 10GBASE-LRM
68.10.1 Introduction
68.10.2 Identification
68.10.2.1 Implementation identification
68.10.2.2 Protocol summary
2734 68.10.2.3 Major capabilities/options
68.10.3 PICS proforma tables for physical medium dependent (PMD) sublayer type 10GBASE-LRM
68.10.3.1 PMD functional specifications
2735 68.10.3.2 Management functions
68.10.3.3 PMD to MDI optical specifications
2736 68.10.3.4 Definitions of optical parameters and measurement methods
68.10.3.5 Safety, installation, environment, and labeling
2737 68.10.3.6 Characteristics of the fiber optic cabling (channel)
2739 69. Introduction to Ethernet operation over electrical backplanes
69.1 Overview
69.1.1 Scope
69.1.2 Objectives
2740 69.1.3 Relationship of Backplane Ethernet to the ISO OSI reference model
2741 69.2 Summary of Backplane Ethernet Sublayers
69.2.1 Reconciliation sublayer and media independent interfaces
69.2.2 Management interface
69.2.3 Physical Layer signaling systems
2742 69.2.4 Auto-Negotiation
69.2.5 Management
69.3 Delay constraints
2743 69.4 State diagrams
69.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma
2745 70. Physical Medium Dependent Sublayer and Baseband Medium, Type 1000BASE-KX
70.1 Overview
70.2 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) service interface
70.3 PCS requirements for Auto-Negotiation (AN) service interface
70.4 Delay constraints
2746 70.5 PMD MDIO function mapping
70.6 PMD functional specifications
70.6.1 Link block diagram
2747 70.6.2 PMD transmit function
70.6.3 PMD receive function
70.6.4 PMD signal detect function
70.6.5 PMD transmit disable function
70.6.6 Loopback mode
2748 70.6.7 PMD fault function
70.6.8 PMD transmit fault function
70.6.9 PMD receive fault function
70.7 1000BASE-KX electrical characteristics
70.7.1 Transmitter characteristics
2749 70.7.1.1 Test fixtures
70.7.1.2 Test fixture impedance
70.7.1.3 Signaling speed
70.7.1.4 Differential output eye mask
2750 70.7.1.5 Output amplitude
70.7.1.6 Differential output return loss
2751 70.7.1.7 Transition time
70.7.1.8 Transmit jitter
70.7.1.9 Transmit jitter test requirements
2752 70.7.2 Receiver characteristics
70.7.2.1 Receiver interference tolerance
70.7.2.2 Signaling speed range
2753 70.7.2.3 AC-coupling
70.7.2.4 Input signal amplitude
70.7.2.5 Differential input return loss
70.8 Interconnect characteristics
70.9 Environmental specifications
70.9.1 General safety
70.9.2 Network safety
70.9.3 Installation and maintenance guidelines
70.9.4 Electromagnetic compatibility
2754 70.9.5 Temperature and humidity
2755 70.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 70, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 1000BASE-KX
70.10.1 Introduction
70.10.2 Identification
70.10.2.1 Implementation identification
70.10.2.2 Protocol summary
2756 70.10.3 Major capabilities/options
2757 70.10.4 PICS proforma tables for Clause 70, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 1000BASE-KX.
70.10.4.1 PMD functional specifications
70.10.4.2 Management functions
2758 70.10.4.3 Transmitter electrical characteristics
70.10.4.4 Receiver electrical characteristics
2759 70.10.4.5 Environmental and safety specifications
2761 71. Physical Medium Dependent Sublayer and Baseband Medium, Type 10GBASE-KX4
71.1 Overview
71.2 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) service interface
71.3 PCS requirements for Auto-Negotiation (AN) service interface
71.4 Delay constraints
2762 71.5 PMD MDIO function mapping
71.6 PMD functional specifications
2763 71.6.1 Link block diagram
71.6.2 PMD Transmit function
71.6.3 PMD Receive function
2764 71.6.4 Global PMD signal detect function
71.6.5 PMD lane-by-lane signal detect function
71.6.6 Global PMD transmit disable function
71.6.7 PMD lane-by-lane transmit disable function
71.6.8 Loopback mode
2765 71.6.9 PMD fault function
71.6.10 PMD transmit fault function
71.6.11 PMD receive fault function
71.7 Electrical characteristics for 10GBASE-KX4
71.7.1 Transmitter characteristics
2766 71.7.1.1 Test fixtures
71.7.1.2 Test fixture impedance
71.7.1.3 Signaling speed
71.7.1.4 Output amplitude
2767 71.7.1.5 Output return loss
2768 71.7.1.6 Differential output template
2769 71.7.1.7 Transition time
71.7.1.8 Transmit jitter
71.7.1.9 Transmit jitter test requirements
2770 71.7.2 Receiver characteristics
71.7.2.1 Receiver interference tolerance
71.7.2.2 Signaling speed
2771 71.7.2.3 AC-coupling
71.7.2.4 Input signal amplitude
71.7.2.5 Differential input return loss
71.8 Interconnect characteristics
71.9 Environmental specifications
71.9.1 General safety
71.9.2 Network safety
71.9.3 Installation and maintenance guidelines
71.9.4 Electromagnetic compatibility
2772 71.9.5 Temperature and humidity
2773 71.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 71, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-KX4
71.10.1 Introduction
71.10.2 Identification
71.10.2.1 Implementation identification
71.10.2.2 Protocol summary
2774 71.10.3 Major capabilities/options
71.10.4 PICS proforma tables for Clause 71, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-KX4
71.10.4.1 PCS requirements for AN service interface
2775 71.10.4.2 PMD functional specifications
2776 71.10.4.3 Management functions
2777 71.10.4.4 Transmitter electrical characteristics
2778 71.10.4.5 Receiver electrical characteristics
71.10.4.6 Environmental and safety specifications
2779 72. Physical Medium Dependent Sublayer and Baseband Medium, Type 10GBASE-KR
72.1 Overview
72.2 Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) service interface
72.3 PCS requirements for Auto-Negotiation (AN) service interface
72.4 Delay constraints
2780 72.5 PMD MDIO function mapping
72.6 PMD functional specifications
72.6.1 Link block diagram
2781 72.6.2 PMD transmit function
72.6.3 PMD receive function
72.6.4 PMD signal detect function
2782 72.6.5 PMD transmit disable function
72.6.6 Loopback mode
72.6.7 PMD_fault function
72.6.8 PMD transmit fault function
72.6.9 PMD receive fault function
2783 72.6.10 PMD control function
72.6.10.1 Overview
72.6.10.2 Training frame structure
72.6.10.2.1 Frame marker
2784 72.6.10.2.2 Control channel encoding
72.6.10.2.3 Coefficient update field
2786 72.6.10.2.4 Status report field
2787 72.6.10.2.5 Coefficient update process
72.6.10.2.6 Training pattern
72.6.10.3 State variables
72.6.10.3.1 Variables
2790 72.6.10.3.2 Timers
72.6.10.3.3 Counters
72.6.10.3.4 Functions
2791 72.6.10.4 State diagrams
72.6.10.4.1 Frame lock
72.6.10.4.2 Training
72.6.10.4.3 Coefficient update
2795 72.7 10GBASE-KR electrical characteristics
72.7.1 Transmitter characteristics
72.7.1.1 Test fixture
2796 72.7.1.2 Test fixture impedance
72.7.1.3 Signaling speed
72.7.1.4 Output amplitude
2797 72.7.1.5 Differential output return loss
2798 72.7.1.6 Common-mode output return loss
2799 72.7.1.7 Transition time
72.7.1.8 Transmit jitter
72.7.1.9 Transmit jitter test requirements
2800 72.7.1.10 Transmitter output waveform
2801 72.7.1.11 Transmitter output waveform requirements
2803 72.7.2 Receiver characteristics
2804 72.7.2.1 Receiver interference tolerance
72.7.2.2 Signaling speed range
72.7.2.3 AC-coupling
72.7.2.4 Input signal amplitude
2805 72.7.2.5 Differential input return loss
72.8 Interconnect characteristics
72.9 Environmental specifications
72.9.1 General safety
72.9.2 Network safety
72.9.3 Installation and maintenance guidelines
72.9.4 Electromagnetic compatibility
72.9.5 Temperature and humidity
2806 72.10 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 72, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-KR
72.10.1 Introduction
72.10.2 Identification
72.10.2.1 Implementation identification
72.10.2.2 Protocol summary
2807 72.10.3 Major capabilities/options
72.10.4 PICS proforma tables for Clause 72, Physical Medium Dependent (PMD) sublayer and baseband medium, type 10GBASE-KR
72.10.4.1 PCS requirements for AN service interface
2808 72.10.4.2 PMD functional specifications
72.10.4.3 Management functions
2809 72.10.4.4 PMD Control functions
2811 72.10.4.5 Transmitter electrical characteristics
2813 72.10.4.6 Receiver electrical characteristics
72.10.4.7 Environmental specifications
2815 73. Auto-Negotiation for Backplane Ethernet
73.1 Auto-Negotiation introduction
73.2 Relationship to the ISO/IEC Open Systems Interconnection (OSI) reference model
2816 73.3 Functional specifications
2817 73.4 Transmit function requirements
73.5 DME transmission
73.5.1 DME page encoding
73.5.1.1 DME electrical specifications
73.5.2 DME page encoding
2818 73.5.3 DME page timing
2819 73.5.3.1 Manchester violation delimiter
2820 73.6 Link codeword encoding
73.6.1 Selector Field
73.6.2 Echoed Nonce Field
2821 73.6.3 Transmitted Nonce Field
73.6.4 Technology Ability Field
73.6.5 FEC capability
2822 73.6.6 Pause Ability
73.6.7 Remote Fault
73.6.8 Acknowledge
73.6.9 Next Page
2823 73.6.10 Transmit Switch function
73.7 Receive function requirements
73.7.1 DME page reception
73.7.2 Receive Switch function
73.7.3 Link codeword matching
73.7.4 Arbitration function requirements
73.7.4.1 Parallel Detection function
2824 73.7.5 Renegotiation function
73.7.6 Priority Resolution function
2825 73.7.7 Next Page function
73.7.7.1 Next page encodings
2826 73.7.7.1.1 Use of next pages
2827 73.8 Management register requirements
73.9 Technology-Dependent interface
73.9.1 AN_LINK.indication
2828 73.9.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
73.9.1.2 When generated
73.9.1.3 Effect of receipt
73.10 State diagrams and variable definitions
73.10.1 State diagram variables
2834 73.10.2 State diagram timers
2837 73.10.3 State diagram counters
2838 73.10.4 .State diagrams
2841 73.11 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 73, Auto-Negotiation for Backplane Ethernet
73.11.1 Introduction
73.11.2 Identification
73.11.2.1 Implementation identification
73.11.2.2 Protocol summary
2842 73.11.3 Major capabilities/options
73.11.4 PICS proforma tables for Auto-Negotiation for Backplane Ethernet.
73.11.4.1 Functional specifications
2843 73.11.4.2 DME transmission
2844 73.11.4.3 Link codeword encoding
2845 73.11.4.4 Receive function requirements
2846 73.11.4.5 Next Page function
73.11.4.6 Management register requirements
2847 73.11.4.7 State diagrams and variable definitions
73.11.4.8 Service primitives
2848 73.11.4.9 Auto-Negotiation annexes
2849 74. Forward Error Correction (FEC) sublayer for 10GBASE-R PHYs
74.1 Overview
74.2 Objectives
74.3 Relationship to other sublayers
2850 74.4 Inter-sublayer interfaces
2851 74.4.1 Functional Block Diagram
74.5 FEC service interface
2852 74.5.1 FEC_UNITDATA.request
74.5.1.1 Semantics of the service primitive
74.5.1.2 When generated
74.5.1.3 Effect of receipt
74.5.2 FEC_UNITDATA.indication
74.5.2.1 Semantics of the service primitive
74.5.2.2 When generated
2853 74.5.2.3 Effect of receipt
74.5.3 FEC_SIGNAL.indication
74.5.3.1 Semantics of the service primitive
74.5.3.2 When generated
74.5.3.3 Effect of receipt
74.6 Delay constraints
74.7 FEC principle of operation
74.7.1 FEC code
2854 74.7.2 FEC block format
74.7.3 Composition of the FEC block
2855 74.7.4 Functions within FEC sublayer
74.7.4.1 Reverse gearbox function
74.7.4.2 FEC Encoder
2856 74.7.4.3 FEC transmission bit ordering
74.7.4.4 FEC (2112, 2080) encoder
2857 74.7.4.4.1 PN-2112 pseudo-noise sequence generator
2858 74.7.4.5 FEC decoder
2859 74.7.4.5.1 FEC (2112,2080) decoding
2860 74.7.4.6 FEC receive bit ordering
74.7.4.7 FEC block synchronization
2861 74.8 FEC MDIO function mapping
74.8.1 FEC capability
2862 74.8.2 FEC Enable
74.8.3 FEC Enable Error Indication
74.8.3.1 FEC Error Indication ability
74.8.4 FEC Error monitoring capability
74.8.4.1 FEC_corrected_blocks_counter
74.8.4.2 FEC_uncorrected_blocks_counter
2863 74.9 10GBASE-R PHY test-pattern mode
74.10 Detailed functions and state diagrams
74.10.1 State diagram conventions
74.10.2 State variables
74.10.2.1 Constants
74.10.2.2 Variables
2864 74.10.2.3 Functions
74.10.2.4 Counters
74.10.3 State diagrams
2866 74.11 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Clause 74, Forward Error Correction (FEC) sublayer for 10GBASE-R PHYs
74.11.1 Introduction
74.11.2 Identification
74.11.2.1 Implementation identification
74.11.2.2 Protocol summary
2867 74.11.3 Major capabilities/options
2868 74.11.4 Management
2869 74.11.5 FEC Requirements
2870 74.11.6 FEC Error Monitoring
2871 Annex 57A (normative) Requirements for support of Slow Protocols
57A.1 Introduction and rationale
57A.2 Slow Protocol transmission characteristics
57A.3 Addressing
2872 57A.4 Protocol identification
2873 57A.5 Handling of Slow Protocol frames
2874 57A.6 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Annex 57A, Requirements for support of Slow Protocols
57A.6.1 Introduction
57A.6.2 Identification
57A.6.2.1 Implementation identification
57A.6.2.2 Protocol summary
2875 57A.6.2.3 Transmission characteristics
57A.6.2.4 Frame handling
2876 Annex 57B (normative) Organization specific slow protocol (OSSP)
57B.1 Transmission and representation of octets
57B.1.1 OSSPDU frame structure
2878 57B.2 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Annex 57B, Organization specific slow protocol (OSSP)
57B.2.1 Introduction
57B.2.2 Identification
57B.2.2.1 Implementation identification
57B.2.2.2 Protocol summary
2879 57B.2.2.3 OSSPDU structure
2881 Annex 58A (informative) Frame-based testing
2883 Annex 61A (informative) EFM Copper examples
61A.1 Purpose and scope
61A.2 Aggregation Discovery example
2887 61A.3 Example of 64/65-octet encapsulation
2891 Annex 61B (normative) Handshake codepoints for 2BASE-TL and 10PASS-TS
61B.1 Purpose and scope
61B.2 Level-1 S field codepoints for 2BASE-TL and 10PASS-TS
61B.3 Codepoints for 2BASE-TL
61B.3.1 Level-2 S field codepoints for 2BASE-TL
2893 61B.3.2 Level-3 S field codepoints for 2BASE-TL
61B.3.2.1 Training parameter codepoints
2903 61B.3.2.2 PMMS parameter codepoints
2910 61B.3.2.3 Framing parameter codepoints
2911 61B.4 Codepoints for 10PASS-TS
61B.4.1 Level-2 S field codepoints for 10PASS-TS
2912 61B.4.2 Level-3 S field codepoints for 10PASS-TS
61B.4.2.1 Used bands in upstream codepoints
2913 61B.4.2.2 Used bands in downstream codepoints
2914 61B.4.2.3 IDFT/DFT size codepoints
61B.4.2.4 Initial length of CE codepoints
2915 61B.4.2.5 MCM RFI band codepoints
2917 61B.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Annex 61B, Handshake codepoints for 2BASE-TL and 10PASS-TS
61B.5.1 Introduction
61B.5.2 Identification
61B.5.2.1 Implementation identification
61B.5.2.2 Protocol summary
61B.5.3 Major capabilities/options
2918 61B.5.4 2BASE-TL handshake coding rules
2919 Annex 62A (normative) PMD profiles for 10PASS-TS
62A.1 Introduction and rationale
62A.2 Relationship to other clauses
62A.3 Profile definitions
62A.3.1 Bandplan and PSD mask profiles
2921 62A.3.2 Bandplan definitions
62A.3.3 PSD mask definitions
62A.3.4 UPBO Reference PSD Profiles
2922 62A.3.5 Band Notch Profiles
2924 62A.3.6 Payload rate profiles
62A.3.7 Complete profiles
62A.3.8 Default profile
2925 62A.4 Register settings
2927 62A.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Annex 62A, PMD profiles for 10PASS-TS
62A.5.1 Introduction
62A.5.2 Identification
62A.5.2.1 Implementation identification
62A.5.2.2 Protocol summary
62A.5.3 Major capabilities/options
2928 62A.5.4 PICS proforma tables for PMD profiles for 10PASS-TS
2931 Annex 62B (normative) Performance guidelines for 10PASS-TS PMD profiles
62B.1 Introduction and rationale
62B.2 Relationship to other clauses
62B.3 Performance test cases
2933 62B.3.1 Additional tests
62B.4 Deployment guidelines
2934 62B.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Annex 62B, Performance guidelines for 10PASS-TS PMD profiles
62B.5.1 Introduction
62B.5.2 Identification
62B.5.2.1 Implementation identification
62B.5.2.2 Protocol summary
2935 62B.5.3 Major capabilities/options
62B.5.4 PICS proforma tables for Performance guidelines for 10PASS-TS PMD profiles
2937 Annex 62C (informative) 10PASS-TS Examples
62C.1 Introduction
62C.2 Bandplan configuration
2940 62C.2.1 Plan A with variable LF region
2941 62C.3 PSD mask configuration
62C.3.1 General procedure
62C.3.2 PSD Masks for Plan A with variable LF region
2943 Annex 63A (normative) PMD Profiles for 2BASE-TL
63A.1 Introduction and rationale
63A.2 Relationship to other clauses
63A.3 Profile definitions
2944 63A.4 Register settings
2945 63A.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma Annex 63A, PMD Profiles for 2BASE-TL
63A.5.1 Introduction
63A.5.2 Identification
63A.5.2.1 Implementation identification
63A.5.2.2 Protocol summary
2946 63A.5.3 Major capabilities/options
63A.5.4 PICS proforma tables for Performance guidelines for 2BASE-TL PMD profiles
2947 Annex 63B (normative) Performance guidelines for 2BASE-TL PMD profiles
63B.1 Introduction and rationale
63B.2 Relationship to other clauses
63B.3 Performance test cases.
2949 63B.4 Deployment Guidelines
2950 63B.5 Protocol implementation conformance statement (PICS) proforma for Annex 63B, Performance guidelines for 2BASE-TL PMD profiles
63B.5.1 Introduction
63B.5.2 Identification
63B.5.2.1 Implementation identification
63B.5.2.2 Protocol summary
2951 63B.5.3 Major capabilities/options
63B.5.4 PICS proforma tables for Performance guidelines for 2BASE-TL PMD profiles
2953 Annex 67A (informative) Environmental characteristics for Ethernet subscriber access networks
67A.1 Introduction
67A.1.1 Terminal deployment scenarios
2954 67A.2 Temperature
2956 67A.3 Temperature impact on optical components
67A.3.1 Component case temperature recommendations
2959 Annex 69A (normative) Interference tolerance testing
2963 Annex 69B (informative) Interconnect characteristics
2973 Annex 73A (normative) Next page message code field definitions
2975 Annex 74A (informative) FEC block encoding examples
IEEE 802.3-2008
$250.00